blob: 6f30014eb794c6cc7fa7350c384210b71423809e [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau442e8342010-11-11 23:29:35 +01007 2010/11/11
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
17 This document is formated with 80 columns per line, with even number of
18 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020050
514. Proxies
524.1. Proxy keywords matrix
534.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
54
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100555. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
576. HTTP header manipulation
58
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100597. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200607.1. Matching integers
617.2. Matching strings
627.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
637.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
647.5. Available matching criteria
657.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
667.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
677.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
687.6. Pre-defined ACLs
697.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100707.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071
728. Logging
738.1. Log levels
748.2. Log formats
758.2.1. Default log format
768.2.2. TCP log format
778.2.3. HTTP log format
788.3. Advanced logging options
798.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
808.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
818.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
828.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
838.4. Timing events
848.5. Session state at disconnection
858.6. Non-printable characters
868.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
878.8. Capturing HTTP headers
888.9. Examples of logs
89
909. Statistics and monitoring
919.1. CSV format
929.2. Unix Socket commands
93
94
951. Quick reminder about HTTP
96----------------------------
97
98When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
99fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
100on almost anything found in the contents.
101
102However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
103formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
104correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
105
106
1071.1. The HTTP transaction model
108-------------------------------
109
110The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100111to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
113connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
114will involve a new connection :
115
116 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
117
118In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
119establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
120by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
121length.
122
123Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
124to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
125however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
126response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
127header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
128
129 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
130
131Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
132power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
133but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200134a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135
136A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
137keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
138second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
139page :
140
141 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
142
143This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
144latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
145correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
146the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100147server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200149By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
150connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
151everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
152established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
153sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
154while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
155another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
156sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
157http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
158mode.
159
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160
1611.2. HTTP request
162-----------------
163
164First, let's consider this HTTP request :
165
166 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100167 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
169 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
170 3 User-agent: my small browser
171 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
172 5 Accept: image/png
173
174
1751.2.1. The Request line
176-----------------------
177
178Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
179
180 - a METHOD : GET
181 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
182 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
183
184All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
185which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
186followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
187is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
188desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
189the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
190
191The URI itself can have several forms :
192
193 - A "relative URI" :
194
195 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
196
197 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
198 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
199
200 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
201
202 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
203
204 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
205 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
206 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
207 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
208 must accept this form too.
209
210 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
211 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
212 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100213
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
215 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
216 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
217 other protocols too.
218
219In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
220mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
221on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
222It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
223specific to the language, framework or application in use.
224
225
2261.2.2. The request headers
227--------------------------
228
229The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
230beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
231an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
232Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
233values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
234encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
235the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
236define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
237
238Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
239their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
240"Connection:" header).
241
242The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
243that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
244is one valid form of empty line.
245
246Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
247headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
248about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
249application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
250
251Important note:
252 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
253 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
254 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
255 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
256
257
2581.3. HTTP response
259------------------
260
261An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
262messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
263
264 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
267 2 Content-length: 350
268 3 Content-Type: text/html
269
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200270As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
271codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
272response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100273continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
274the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
275following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
276sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
277(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
278correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
279such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
280state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
281over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
282if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
283information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200284
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285
2861.3.1. The Response line
287------------------------
288
289Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
290
291 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
292 - a status code : 200
293 - a reason : OK
294
295The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
298 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
299 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
300 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
301
302Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100303"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
305messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
306or "Authentication Required".
307
308Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
309
310 Code When / reason
311 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
312 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
313 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
314 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
315 400 for an invalid or too large request
316 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
317 accessing the stats page)
318 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
319 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
320 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
321 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
322 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
323 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
324 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
325 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
326 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
327
328The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3294.2).
330
331
3321.3.2. The response headers
333---------------------------
334
335Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
336the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
337details.
338
339
3402. Configuring HAProxy
341----------------------
342
3432.1. Configuration file format
344------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200345
346HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
347
348 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
349 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
350 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
351 "frontend" and "backend".
352
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100353The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
354referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
355delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100356preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100357escaped by doubling them.
358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
3602.2. Time format
361----------------
362
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100363Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100364values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
365otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
366numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
367for every keyword. Supported units are :
368
369 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
370 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
371 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
372 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
373 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
374 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
375
376
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003772.3. Examples
378-------------
379
380 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
381 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
382 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
383 global
384 daemon
385 maxconn 256
386
387 defaults
388 mode http
389 timeout connect 5000ms
390 timeout client 50000ms
391 timeout server 50000ms
392
393 frontend http-in
394 bind *:80
395 default_backend servers
396
397 backend servers
398 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
399
400
401 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
402 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
403 global
404 daemon
405 maxconn 256
406
407 defaults
408 mode http
409 timeout connect 5000ms
410 timeout client 50000ms
411 timeout server 50000ms
412
413 listen http-in
414 bind *:80
415 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
416
417
418Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
419
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100420 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200421
422
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004233. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200424--------------------
425
426Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
427are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
428of them have command-line equivalents.
429
430The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
431
432 * Process management and security
433 - chroot
434 - daemon
435 - gid
436 - group
437 - log
438 - nbproc
439 - pidfile
440 - uid
441 - ulimit-n
442 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200443 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200444 - node
445 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100446 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100447
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 * Performance tuning
449 - maxconn
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100450 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200451 - noepoll
452 - nokqueue
453 - nopoll
454 - nosepoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100455 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200456 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200457 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200458 - tune.chksize
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100459 - tune.maxaccept
460 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200461 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100462 - tune.rcvbuf.client
463 - tune.rcvbuf.server
464 - tune.sndbuf.client
465 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100466
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200467 * Debugging
468 - debug
469 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200470
471
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004723.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200473------------------------------------
474
475chroot <jail dir>
476 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
477 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
478 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
479 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
480 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
481 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100482
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200483daemon
484 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
485 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
486 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
487
488gid <number>
489 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
490 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
491 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
492 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100493
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200494group <group name>
495 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
496 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100497
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200498log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200499 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
500 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100501 configured with "log global".
502
503 <address> can be one of:
504
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100505 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100506 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
507 port).
508
509 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
510 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
511 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
512 writeable).
513
514 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200515
516 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
517 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
518 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
519
520 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200521 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
522 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
523 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
524 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
525 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
526 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200527
528 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
529
530nbproc <number>
531 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
532 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
533 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
534 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
535 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
536
537pidfile <pidfile>
538 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
539 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
540 starting the process. See also "daemon".
541
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200542stats socket <path> [{uid | user} <uid>] [{gid | group} <gid>] [mode <mode>]
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200543 [level <level>]
544
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200545 Creates a UNIX socket in stream mode at location <path>. Any previously
546 existing socket will be backed up then replaced. Connections to this socket
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100547 will return various statistics outputs and even allow some commands to be
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200548 issued. Please consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
549
550 An optional "level" parameter can be specified to restrict the nature of
551 the commands that can be issued on the socket :
552 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
553 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
554 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
555
556 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
557 be read, and only non-sensible changes are permitted (eg: clear max
558 counters).
559
560 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
561 all counters).
Willy Tarreaua8efd362008-01-03 10:19:15 +0100562
563 On platforms which support it, it is possible to restrict access to this
564 socket by specifying numerical IDs after "uid" and "gid", or valid user and
565 group names after the "user" and "group" keywords. It is also possible to
566 restrict permissions on the socket by passing an octal value after the "mode"
567 keyword (same syntax as chmod). Depending on the platform, the permissions on
568 the socket will be inherited from the directory which hosts it, or from the
569 user the process is started with.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200570
571stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
572 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
573 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100574 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200575
576stats maxconn <connections>
577 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
578 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
579
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200580uid <number>
581 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
582 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
583 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
584 one. See also "gid" and "user".
585
586ulimit-n <number>
587 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
588 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
589 option.
590
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100591unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
592 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
593
594 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
595 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
596 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
597 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
598 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
599 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
600 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
601 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
602 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
603 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
604
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200605user <user name>
606 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
607 See also "uid" and "group".
608
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200609node <name>
610 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
611
612 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
613 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
614 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
615 traffic.
616
617description <text>
618 Add a text that describes the instance.
619
620 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
621 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
622 "<" and ">" characters.
623
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200624
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006253.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200626-----------------------
627
628maxconn <number>
629 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
630 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
631 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
632 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
633
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100634maxpipes <number>
635 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
636 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
637 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
638 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
639 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
640 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
641
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200642noepoll
643 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
644 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
645 used will generally be "poll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
646
647nokqueue
648 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
649 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
650 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
651
652nopoll
653 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
654 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100655 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200656 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll" and
657 "nokqueue".
658
659nosepoll
660 Disables the use of the "speculative epoll" event polling system on Linux. It
661 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-ds". The next polling system
662 used will generally be "epoll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
663
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100664nosplice
665 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
666 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
667 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100668 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100669 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
670 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
671 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
672 "option splice-response".
673
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200674spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
675 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
676 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
677 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
678 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
679 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
680
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200681tune.bufsize <number>
682 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
683 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
684 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
685 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
686 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
687 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
688 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
689 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
690
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200691tune.chksize <number>
692 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
693 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
694 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
695 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
696 checks whenever possible.
697
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100698tune.maxaccept <number>
699 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
700 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
701 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100702 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100703 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
704 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100705 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100706 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
707
708tune.maxpollevents <number>
709 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
710 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
711 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
712 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
713 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
714
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200715tune.maxrewrite <number>
716 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
717 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
718 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
719 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
720 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
721 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
722 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
723 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
724 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
725 bufsize.
726
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100727tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
728tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
729 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
730 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
731 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
732 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
733 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
734 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
735 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
736
737tune.sndbuf.client <number>
738tune.sndbuf.server <number>
739 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
740 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
741 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
742 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
743 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
744 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
745 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
746 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
747 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
748 notifying haproxy again.
749
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200750
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007513.3. Debugging
752--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200753
754debug
755 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
756 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
757 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
758 system startup.
759
760quiet
761 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
762 line argument "-q".
763
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200764
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007653.4. Userlists
766--------------
767It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
768http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
769it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
770
771userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100772 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100773 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
774
775group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100776 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100777 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
778 proceeded by "users" keyword.
779
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100780user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
781 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100782 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
783 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100784 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
785 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100786 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
787 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
788
789
790 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100791 userlist L1
792 group G1 users tiger,scott
793 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100794
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100795 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
796 user scott insecure-password elgato
797 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100798
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100799 userlist L2
800 group G1
801 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100802
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100803 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
804 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
805 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100806
807 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200808
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200809
8103.5. Peers
811--------------
812It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
813haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
814pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
815identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
816or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
817Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
818known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
819the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
820process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
821during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
822tables.
823
824peers <peersect>
825 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independant section,
826 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
827
828peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
829 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
830 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
831 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
832 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
833 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
834 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
835
836 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
837 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
838
839 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
840 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
841 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
842 across all peers.
843
844Example:
845 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100846 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
847 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
848 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200849
850 backend mybackend
851 mode tcp
852 balance roundrobin
853 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
854 stick on src
855
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100856 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
857 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200858
859
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008604. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200861----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100862
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200863Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
864 - defaults <name>
865 - frontend <name>
866 - backend <name>
867 - listen <name>
868
869A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
870its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
871section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100872section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200873
874A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
875connections.
876
877A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
878to forward incoming connections.
879
880A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
881parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
882
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100883All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
884'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
885case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
886
887Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
888logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
889proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
890However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
891name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
892
893Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
894and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100895bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100896protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
897modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
898arbitrary criteria.
899
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100900
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009014.1. Proxy keywords matrix
902--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100903
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200904The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
905limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
906they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
907limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100908marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200909option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +0200910and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
911with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
912specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100913
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200914
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100915 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
916------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
917acl - X X X
918appsession - - X X
919backlog X X X -
920balance X - X X
921bind - X X -
922bind-process X X X X
923block - X X X
924capture cookie - X X -
925capture request header - X X -
926capture response header - X X -
927clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
928contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
929cookie X - X X
930default-server X - X X
931default_backend X X X -
932description - X X X
933disabled X X X X
934dispatch - - X X
935enabled X X X X
936errorfile X X X X
937errorloc X X X X
938errorloc302 X X X X
939-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
940errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200941force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100942fullconn X - X X
943grace X X X X
944hash-type X - X X
945http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100946http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +0200947http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100948http-request - X X X
949id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200950ignore-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100951log X X X X
952maxconn X X X -
953mode X X X X
954monitor fail - X X -
955monitor-net X X X -
956monitor-uri X X X -
957option abortonclose (*) X - X X
958option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
959option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
960option allbackups (*) X - X X
961option checkcache (*) X - X X
962option clitcpka (*) X X X -
963option contstats (*) X X X -
964option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
965option dontlognull (*) X X X -
966option forceclose (*) X X X X
967-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
968option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +0200969option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100970option http-server-close (*) X X X X
971option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
972option httpchk X - X X
973option httpclose (*) X X X X
974option httplog X X X X
975option http_proxy (*) X X X X
976option independant-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +0200977option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100978option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
979option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
980option logasap (*) X X X -
981option mysql-check X - X X
982option nolinger (*) X X X X
983option originalto X X X X
984option persist (*) X - X X
985option redispatch (*) X - X X
986option smtpchk X - X X
987option socket-stats (*) X X X -
988option splice-auto (*) X X X X
989option splice-request (*) X X X X
990option splice-response (*) X X X X
991option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
992option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
993-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
994option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
995option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
996option tcpka X X X X
997option tcplog X X X X
998option transparent (*) X - X X
999persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1000rate-limit sessions X X X -
1001redirect - X X X
1002redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1003redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1004reqadd - X X X
1005reqallow - X X X
1006reqdel - X X X
1007reqdeny - X X X
1008reqiallow - X X X
1009reqidel - X X X
1010reqideny - X X X
1011reqipass - X X X
1012reqirep - X X X
1013reqisetbe - X X X
1014reqitarpit - X X X
1015reqpass - X X X
1016reqrep - X X X
1017-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1018reqsetbe - X X X
1019reqtarpit - X X X
1020retries X - X X
1021rspadd - X X X
1022rspdel - X X X
1023rspdeny - X X X
1024rspidel - X X X
1025rspideny - X X X
1026rspirep - X X X
1027rsprep - X X X
1028server - - X X
1029source X - X X
1030srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001031stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001032stats auth X - X X
1033stats enable X - X X
1034stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001035stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001036stats realm X - X X
1037stats refresh X - X X
1038stats scope X - X X
1039stats show-desc X - X X
1040stats show-legends X - X X
1041stats show-node X - X X
1042stats uri X - X X
1043-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1044stick match - - X X
1045stick on - - X X
1046stick store-request - - X X
1047stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001048tcp-request connection - X X -
1049tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001050tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001051tcp-response content - - X X
1052tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001053timeout check X - X X
1054timeout client X X X -
1055timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1056timeout connect X - X X
1057timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1058timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1059timeout http-request X X X X
1060timeout queue X - X X
1061timeout server X - X X
1062timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1063timeout tarpit X X X X
1064transparent (deprecated) X - X X
1065use_backend - X X -
1066------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1067 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001068
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001069
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010704.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1071---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001072
1073This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1074
1075
1076acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1077 Declare or complete an access list.
1078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1079 no | yes | yes | yes
1080 Example:
1081 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1082 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1083 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1084
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001085 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001086
1087
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001088appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1089 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001090 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1092 no | no | yes | yes
1093 Arguments :
1094 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1095 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1096
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001097 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001098 checked in each cookie value.
1099
1100 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1101 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1102 milliseconds.
1103
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001104 request-learn
1105 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1106 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1107 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1108 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1109 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1110 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1111
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001112 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1113 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1114 data following this prefix.
1115
1116 Example :
1117 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1118
1119 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1120 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1121
1122 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1123 2 modes are currently supported :
1124 - path-parameters :
1125 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1126 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1127 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1128 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1129 - query-string :
1130 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1131 query string.
1132
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001133 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1134 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1135 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1136 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001137 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1138 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1139 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001140 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1141 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1142
1143 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1144
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001145 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1146 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1147 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1148
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001149 Example :
1150 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1151
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001152 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1153 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001154
1155
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001156backlog <conns>
1157 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1158 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1159 yes | yes | yes | no
1160 Arguments :
1161 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1162 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
1163 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
1164
1165 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1166 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1167 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1168 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1169 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1170 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1171 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1172 backlog parameter.
1173
1174 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1175 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1176 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1177
1178 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1179
1180
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001181balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001182balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001183 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1185 yes | no | yes | yes
1186 Arguments :
1187 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1188 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1189 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1190 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1191
1192 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1193 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1194 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1195 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001196 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1197 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1198 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1199 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1200 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1201 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1202 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1203 it, so that you don't worry.
1204
1205 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1206 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1207 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1208 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1209 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1210 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1211 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1212 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001213
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001214 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1215 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1216 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1217 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1218 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1219 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1220 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1221 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1222
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001223 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1224 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1225 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1226 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1227 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1228 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1229 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1230 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001231 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001232 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001233 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1234 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1235 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001236
1237 uri The left part of the URI (before the question mark) is hashed
1238 and divided by the total weight of the running servers. The
1239 result designates which server will receive the request. This
1240 ensures that a same URI will always be directed to the same
1241 server as long as no server goes up or down. This is used
1242 with proxy caches and anti-virus proxies in order to maximize
1243 the cache hit rate. Note that this algorithm may only be used
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001244 in an HTTP backend. This algorithm is static by default,
1245 which means that changing a server's weight on the fly will
1246 have no effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001247
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001248 This algorithm support two optional parameters "len" and
1249 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1250 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1251 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1252 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1253 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1254 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1255 URIs start with a leading "/".
1256
1257 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1258 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1259 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1260 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1261
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001262 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001263 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1264
1265 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
1266 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1267 when the question mark indicating a query string ('?') is not
1268 present in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1269 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1270 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1271 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1272 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1273 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1274 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1275 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1276 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1277 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1278 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1279 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1280 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1281 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1282 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1283 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1284 be randomly balanced if at all.
1285
1286 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1287 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1288 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1289 server will receive the request.
1290
1291 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1292 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1293 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1294 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1295 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001296 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1297 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1298 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001299
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001300 hdr(name) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP request.
1301 Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function, the header
1302 name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the header is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001303 absent or if it does not contain any value, the roundrobin
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001304 algorithm is applied instead.
1305
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001306 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001307 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1308 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1309 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1310
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001311 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1312 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1313 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1314
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001315 rdp-cookie
1316 rdp-cookie(name)
1317 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1318 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1319 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1320 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1321 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1322 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001323 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001324 used instead.
1325
1326 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1327 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1328 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1329 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1330
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001331 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1332 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1333 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1334
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001335 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001336 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1337 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001338
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001339 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001340 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001341
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001342 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1343 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1344 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001345
1346 Examples :
1347 balance roundrobin
1348 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001349 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001350 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1351 balance hdr(host)
1352 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001353
1354 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1355 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1356
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001357 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001358 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1359 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1360 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1361 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1362
1363 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1364 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1365 defaults to 16 kB.
1366
1367 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1368 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1369
1370 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1371 Round Robin.
1372
1373 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1374 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1375 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1376 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1377
1378 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1379
1380 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001381 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001382 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1383 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1384 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001385
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001386 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1387 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001388
1389
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001390bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...]
1391bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] interface <interface>
1392bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] mss <maxseg>
1393bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] transparent
1394bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] id <id>
1395bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] name <name>
1396bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] defer-accept
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001397bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] accept-proxy
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001398bind /<path> [, ...]
1399bind /<path> [, ...] mode <mode>
1400bind /<path> [, ...] [ user <user> | uid <uid> ]
1401bind /<path> [, ...] [ group <user> | gid <gid> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001402 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1404 no | yes | yes | no
1405 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001406 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1407 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1408 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1409 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
1410 special address "0.0.0.0".
1411
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001412 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1413 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001414 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1415 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1416 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001417 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1418 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1419 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1420 the range.
1421
1422 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1423 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1424 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1425 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1426 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1427 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1428 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
1429 privileges to start the program, which are independant of
1430 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001431
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001432 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1433 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1434 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1435 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1436 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1437 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1438 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1439 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1440
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001441 <interface> is an optional physical interface name. This is currently
1442 only supported on Linux. The interface must be a physical
1443 interface, not an aliased interface. When specified, all
1444 addresses on the same line will only be accepted if the
1445 incoming packet physically come through the designated
1446 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to
1447 the same address if they are bound to different interfaces.
1448 Note that binding to a physical interface requires root
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001449 privileges. This parameter is only compatible with TCP
1450 sockets.
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001451
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001452 <maxseg> is an optional TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be
1453 advertised on incoming connections. This can be used to force
1454 a lower MSS for certain specific ports, for instance for
1455 connections passing through a VPN. Note that this relies on a
1456 kernel feature which is theorically supported under Linux but
1457 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not
1458 work on other operating systems. The commonly advertised
1459 value on Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP).
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001460 This parameter is only compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001461
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02001462 <id> is a persistent value for socket ID. Must be positive and
1463 unique in the proxy. An unused value will automatically be
1464 assigned if unset. Can only be used when defining only a
1465 single socket.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02001466
1467 <name> is an optional name provided for stats
1468
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001469 <mode> is the octal mode used to define access permissions on the
1470 UNIX socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1471 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1472 simply ignore this.
1473
1474 <user> is the name of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1475 socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1476 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1477 simply ignore this.
1478
1479 <group> is the name of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1480 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1481 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1482 this.
1483
1484 <uid> is the uid of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1485 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1486 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1487 this.
1488
1489 <gid> is the gid of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1490 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1491 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1492 this.
1493
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001494 transparent is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
1495 Linux kernels. It indicates that the addresses will be bound
1496 even if they do not belong to the local machine. Any packet
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001497 targeting any of these addresses will be caught just as if
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001498 the address was locally configured. This normally requires
1499 that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with
1500 the default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for
1501 the specified port. This keyword is available only when
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001502 HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1. This parameter is
1503 only compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001504
Willy Tarreau59f89202010-10-02 11:54:00 +02001505 defer-accept is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
Willy Tarreaucb6cd432009-10-13 07:34:14 +02001506 Linux kernels. It states that a connection will only be
1507 accepted once some data arrive on it, or at worst after the
1508 first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols for
1509 which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly
1510 improve performance by ensuring that most of the request is
1511 already available when the connection is accepted. On the
1512 other hand, it will not be able to detect connections which
1513 don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
1514 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is
1515 never accepted until the client talks. This can cause issues
1516 with front firewalls which would see an established
1517 connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV.
1518
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001519 accept-proxy is an optional keyword which enforces use of the PROXY
1520 protocol over any connection accepted by this listener. The
1521 PROXY protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of the
1522 incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used,
1523 with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules
1524 which will only see the real connection address. Logs will
1525 reflect the addresses indicated in the protocol, unless it is
1526 violated, in which case the real address will still be used.
1527 This keyword combined with support from external components
1528 can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
1529 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and
1530 not even always usable.
1531
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001532 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1533 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1534 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1535 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1536 in a frontend.
1537
1538 Example :
1539 listen http_proxy
1540 bind :80,:443
1541 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001542 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001543
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001544 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001545 documentation.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001546
1547
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001548bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
1549 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1551 yes | yes | yes | yes
1552 Arguments :
1553 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1554 may be used to override a default value.
1555
1556 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1557 option may be combined with other numbers.
1558
1559 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1560 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1561 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1562 missing from all processes.
1563
1564 number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between
1565 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process
1566 number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise
1567 some instances might be missing from all processes.
1568
1569 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1570 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1571 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1572 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1573 and 'even' instances.
1574
1575 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1576 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1577 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1578 32.
1579
1580 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1581 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1582
1583 Example :
1584 listen app_ip1
1585 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001586 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001587
1588 listen app_ip2
1589 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001590 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001591
1592 listen management
1593 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001594 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001595
1596 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1597
1598
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001599block { if | unless } <condition>
1600 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1602 no | yes | yes | yes
1603
1604 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1605 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001606 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001607 typically used to deny access to certain sensible resources if some
1608 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1609 "block" statements per instance.
1610
1611 Example:
1612 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1613 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1614 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1615 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1616
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001617 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001618
1619
1620capture cookie <name> len <length>
1621 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1623 no | yes | yes | no
1624 Arguments :
1625 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1626 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1627 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1628 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1629 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1630
1631 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1632 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1633 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1634 right if it exceeds <length>.
1635
1636 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1637 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1638 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1639 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1640
1641 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1642 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1643 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1644
1645 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1646 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1647 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1648 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001649 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001650 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1651
1652 Example:
1653 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1654
1655 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001656 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001657
1658
1659capture request header <name> len <length>
1660 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1662 no | yes | yes | no
1663 Arguments :
1664 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001665 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001666 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1667 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1668 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1669
1670 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1671 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1672 it exceeds <length>.
1673
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001674 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001675 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1676 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001677 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1678 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1679 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1680 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001681 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001682 environments to find where the request came from.
1683
1684 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1685 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1686 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1687 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001688
1689 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1690 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1691 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1692 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1693
1694 Example:
1695 capture request header Host len 15
1696 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1697 capture request header Referrer len 15
1698
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001699 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001700 about logging.
1701
1702
1703capture response header <name> len <length>
1704 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1706 no | yes | yes | no
1707 Arguments :
1708 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001709 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001710 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1711 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1712 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1713
1714 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1715 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1716 it exceeds <length>.
1717
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001718 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001719 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1720 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1721 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001722 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1723 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1724 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1725 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001726
1727 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1728 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1729 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1730 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1731
1732 Example:
1733 capture response header Content-length len 9
1734 capture response header Location len 15
1735
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001736 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001737 about logging.
1738
1739
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001740clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001741 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1743 yes | yes | yes | no
1744 Arguments :
1745 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1746 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1747 as explained at the top of this document.
1748
1749 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1750 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1751 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1752 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1753 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1754 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1755 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1756 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001757 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001758 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1759 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1760
1761 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1762 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1763 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1764 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1765 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1766 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1767
1768 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1769 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1770
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001771 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1772 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001773
1774
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001775contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001776 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1778 yes | no | yes | yes
1779 Arguments :
1780 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1781 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1782 as explained at the top of this document.
1783
1784 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001785 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001786 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001787 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1788 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1789 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1790 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1791
1792 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1793 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1794 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1795 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1796 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1797 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1798
1799 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1800 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1801 instead.
1802
1803 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1804 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1805
1806
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001807cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001808 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ domain <domain> ]*
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001809 [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001810 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1812 yes | no | yes | yes
1813 Arguments :
1814 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1815 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1816 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1817 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1818 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1819 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1820 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1821 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1822 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1823
1824 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1825 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1826 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1827 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1828 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1829 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1830 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1831 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1832 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1833 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1834 "insert" and "prefix".
1835
1836 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001837 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001838
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001839 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001840 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
1841 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
1842 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
1843 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
1844 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
1845 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
1846 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
1847 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
1848 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
1849 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001850
1851 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
1852 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
1853 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
1854 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
1855 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
1856 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
1857 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
1858 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
1859 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
1860 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
1861 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert".
1862
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001863 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
1864 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
1865 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001866 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
1867 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
1868 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
1869 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001870
1871 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
1872 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
1873 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
1874 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
1875 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
1876 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
1877 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
1878 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
1879 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
1880
1881 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
1882 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
1883 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
1884 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
1885 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
1886 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
1887 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
1888 persistence cookie in the cache.
1889 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
1890
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001891 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
1892 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
1893 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
1894 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
1895 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
1896 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
1897 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
1898 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
1899 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
1900 they logout.
1901
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001902 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001903 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01001904 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
1905 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
1906 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
1907 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
1908 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
1909 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001910
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001911 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
1912 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
1913 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
1914 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
1915 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
1916 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
1917 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
1918 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1919 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
1920 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
1921 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
1922 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
1923 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
1924 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
1925 the site.
1926
1927 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
1928 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
1929 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
1930 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
1931 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
1932 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
1933 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
1934 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
1935 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
1936 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
1937 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
1938 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
1939 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1940 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
1941 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
1942 redispatch after some absolute delay.
1943
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001944 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
1945 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
1946 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
1947 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001948
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001949 Examples :
1950 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
1951 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
1952 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001953 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001954
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02001955 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001956 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001957
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001958
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001959default-server [param*]
1960 Change default options for a server in a backend
1961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1962 yes | no | yes | yes
1963 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001964 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
1965 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
1966 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
1967 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001968
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001969 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001970 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
1971
1972 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001973
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001974
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001975default_backend <backend>
1976 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
1977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1978 yes | yes | yes | no
1979 Arguments :
1980 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
1981
1982 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
1983 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
1984 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
1985 will catch all undetermined requests.
1986
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001987 Example :
1988
1989 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
1990 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
1991 default_backend dynamic
1992
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001993 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
1994
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001995
1996disabled
1997 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
1998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1999 yes | yes | yes | yes
2000 Arguments : none
2001
2002 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2003 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2004 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2005 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2006 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2007 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2008 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2009
2010 See also : "enabled"
2011
2012
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002013dispatch <address>:<port>
2014 Set a default server address
2015 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2016 no | no | yes | yes
2017 Arguments : none
2018
2019 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2020 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2021 during start-up.
2022
2023 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2024 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2025 possible with normal servers.
2026
2027 The "disabled" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
2028 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2029 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2030 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2031 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2032
2033 See also : "server"
2034
2035
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002036enabled
2037 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2039 yes | yes | yes | yes
2040 Arguments : none
2041
2042 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2043 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2044
2045 See also : "disabled"
2046
2047
2048errorfile <code> <file>
2049 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2051 yes | yes | yes | yes
2052 Arguments :
2053 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2054 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2055
2056 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002057 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002058 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002059 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2060 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002061
2062 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2063 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2064 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2065
2066 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2067 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2068 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2069 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2070
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002071 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2072 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2073 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2074 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2075 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2076 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2077
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002078 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2079 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2080 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002081 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002082 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2083
2084 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2085
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002086 Example :
2087 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2088 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2089 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2090
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002091
2092errorloc <code> <url>
2093errorloc302 <code> <url>
2094 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2096 yes | yes | yes | yes
2097 Arguments :
2098 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2099 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2100
2101 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2102 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2103 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2104 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2105 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2106
2107 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2108 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2109 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2110
2111 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2112 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2113 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2114 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2115 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2116 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2117 request.
2118
2119 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2120
2121
2122errorloc303 <code> <url>
2123 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2125 yes | yes | yes | yes
2126 Arguments :
2127 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2128 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2129
2130 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2131 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2132 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2133 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2134 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2135
2136 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2137 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2138 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2139
2140 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2141 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2142 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2143 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002144 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002145
2146 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2147
2148
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002149force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2150 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2151 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2152 no | yes | yes | yes
2153
2154 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2155 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2156 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2157 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2158 marked down for maintenance operations.
2159
2160 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2161 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2162 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2163 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2164 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2165 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2166 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2167 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2168 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2169
2170 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2171 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2172 is used.
2173
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002174 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002175 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002176
2177
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002178fullconn <conns>
2179 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2181 yes | no | yes | yes
2182 Arguments :
2183 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2184 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2185
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002186 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002187 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002188 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002189 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2190 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2191 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2192 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2193 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002194 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002195
2196 Example :
2197 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2198 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2199 # connections.
2200 backend dynamic
2201 fullconn 10000
2202 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2203 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2204
2205 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2206
2207
2208grace <time>
2209 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002211 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002212 Arguments :
2213 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2214 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2215 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2216
2217 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2218 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002219 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002220 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2221
2222 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2223 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2224 simplify it.
2225
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002226
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002227hash-type <method>
2228 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2230 yes | no | yes | yes
2231 Arguments :
2232 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2233 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2234 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2235 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2236 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2237 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2238 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2239 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2240 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2241
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002242 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2243 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2244 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2245 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2246 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2247 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2248 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2249 this value.
2250
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002251 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2252 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2253 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2254 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2255 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2256 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2257 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2258 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2259 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2260 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2261 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2262 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2263 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2264
2265 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2266
2267 See also : "balance", "server"
2268
2269
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002270http-check disable-on-404
2271 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2272 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002273 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002274 Arguments : none
2275
2276 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2277 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2278 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2279 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2280 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2281 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2282 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2283 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002284 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2285 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2286 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2287
2288 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2289
2290
2291http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
2292 Make HTTP health checks consider reponse contents or specific status codes
2293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2294 no | no | yes | yes
2295 Arguments :
2296 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2297 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
2298 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceeded by an
2299 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2300 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2301 details on the supported keywords.
2302
2303 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2304 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2305 with the usual backslash ('\').
2306
2307 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2308 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2309 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2310 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2311 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2312
2313 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
2314 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2315 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2316 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2317 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2318
2319 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
2320 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2321 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2322 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2323 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2324 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2325
2326 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
2327 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2328 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2329 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2330 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2331 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2332 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2333 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2334 trace).
2335
2336 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
2337 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2338 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2339 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2340 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2341 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2342 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2343 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2344
2345 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2346 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2347 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2348 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2349 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2350 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2351 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2352 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2353
2354 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2355 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2356
2357 Examples :
2358 # only accept status 200 as valid
2359 http-request expect status 200
2360
2361 # consider SQL errors as errors
2362 http-request expect ! string SQL\ Error
2363
2364 # consider status 5xx only as errors
2365 http-request expect ! rstatus ^5
2366
2367 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
2368 http-request expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002369
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002370 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002371
2372
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002373http-check send-state
2374 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2375 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2376 yes | no | yes | yes
2377 Arguments : none
2378
2379 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2380 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2381 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2382 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2383 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2384
2385 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2386 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2387 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2388 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2389 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2390 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2391 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2392 checked in multiple backends.
2393
2394 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2395 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2396
2397 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2398 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2399 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2400 one fails.
2401
2402 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2403 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2404 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2405
2406 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2407 server's queue.
2408
2409 Example of a header received by the application server :
2410 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2411 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2412
2413 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2414
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002415http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002416 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002417 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2418
2419 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2420 no | yes | yes | yes
2421
2422 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2423 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2424 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002425 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2426 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002427 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2428
2429 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2430 instance.
2431
2432 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002433 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2434 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2435 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002436
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002437 http-request allow if nagios
2438 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2439 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2440 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002441
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002442 Example:
2443 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002444
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002445 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002446
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002447 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2448 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002449
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002450id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002451 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2452 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2453 no | yes | yes | yes
2454 Arguments : none
2455
2456 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2457 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2458 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002459
2460
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002461ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2462 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2463 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2464 no | yes | yes | yes
2465
2466 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2467 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2468 and running).
2469
2470 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2471 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2472 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2473 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2474 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2475
2476 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2477 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2478
2479 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2480 "unless" condition is met.
2481
2482 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2483
2484
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002485log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002486log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002487 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2489 yes | yes | yes | yes
2490 Arguments :
2491 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2492 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2493 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2494 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2495 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2496 parameter.
2497
2498 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2499 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2500
2501 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2502 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2503 standard syslog port).
2504
2505 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2506 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2507 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2508 appropriately writeable).
2509
2510 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2511
2512 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2513 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2514 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2515
2516 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2517 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2518 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002519 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2520 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2521 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2522 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2523 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002524
2525 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2526
2527 Note that up to two "log" entries may be specified per instance. However, if
2528 "log global" is used and if the "global" section already contains 2 log
2529 entries, then additional log entries will be ignored.
2530
2531 Also, it is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002532 what to log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log
2533 entries from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level
2534 "info".
2535
2536 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2537 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2538 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2539 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2540
2541 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2542 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002543
2544 Example :
2545 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002546 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2547 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002548
2549
2550maxconn <conns>
2551 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2553 yes | yes | yes | no
2554 Arguments :
2555 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2556 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2557 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2558 closes.
2559
2560 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2561 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2562 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2563 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2564 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2565 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2566 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2567 properly tuned.
2568
2569 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2570 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2571 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2572
2573 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2574
2575
2576mode { tcp|http|health }
2577 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2579 yes | yes | yes | yes
2580 Arguments :
2581 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2582 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2583 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2584 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2585
2586 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2587 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2588 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2589 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2590 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2591
2592 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
2593 to incoming connections and close the connection. Nothing will be
2594 logged. This mode is used to reply to external components health
2595 checks. This mode is deprecated and should not be used anymore as
2596 it is possible to do the same and even better by combining TCP or
2597 HTTP modes with the "monitor" keyword.
2598
2599 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2600 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2601 will be refused.
2602
2603 Example :
2604 defaults http_instances
2605 mode http
2606
2607 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
2608
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002609
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002610monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002611 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2613 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002614 Arguments :
2615 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2616 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002617 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002618 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2619 backend and its backup.
2620
2621 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2622 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2623 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2624 servers in a list of backends.
2625
2626 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2627 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2628 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2629 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2630 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2631 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2632 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002633 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002634
2635 Example:
2636 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002637 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002638 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2639 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2640 monitor-uri /site_alive
2641 monitor fail if site_dead
2642
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002643 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri"
2644
2645
2646monitor-net <source>
2647 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2649 yes | yes | yes | no
2650 Arguments :
2651 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2652 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2653 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2654 followed by a mask.
2655
2656 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2657 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002658 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002659 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2660
2661 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2662 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2663 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2664 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
2665 running without forwarding the request to a backend server.
2666
2667 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2668 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2669 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2670 nothing more. Right now, it is not possible to set failure conditions on
2671 requests caught by "monitor-net".
2672
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002673 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2674 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
2675
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002676 Example :
2677 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2678 frontend www
2679 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2680
2681 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2682
2683
2684monitor-uri <uri>
2685 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2687 yes | yes | yes | no
2688 Arguments :
2689 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2690 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2691
2692 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2693 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2694 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2695 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2696 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2697 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2698 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2699 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2700
2701 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2702 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2703 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2704 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2705 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2706 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2707
2708 Example :
2709 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2710 frontend www
2711 mode http
2712 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2713
2714 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2715
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002716
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002717option abortonclose
2718no option abortonclose
2719 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2721 yes | no | yes | yes
2722 Arguments : none
2723
2724 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2725 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2726 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2727 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002728 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002729 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2730 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2731 encountered while delivering the response.
2732
2733 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2734 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2735 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2736 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2737 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2738 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002739 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002740 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002741 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002742 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2743 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2744 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2745
2746 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2747 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2748 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2749 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2750 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2751 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2752 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2753 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002754 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002755
2756 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2757 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2758
2759 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2760
2761
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002762option accept-invalid-http-request
2763no option accept-invalid-http-request
2764 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2766 yes | yes | yes | no
2767 Arguments : none
2768
2769 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2770 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2771 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2772 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2773 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2774 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2775 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2776 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2777 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2778
2779 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2780 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2781 been confirmed.
2782
2783 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2784 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
2785 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Doing this
2786 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2787
2788 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2789 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2790
2791 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
2792 stats socket.
2793
2794
2795option accept-invalid-http-response
2796no option accept-invalid-http-response
2797 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
2798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2799 yes | no | yes | yes
2800 Arguments : none
2801
2802 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2803 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2804 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2805 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2806 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2807 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2808 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2809 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2810 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2811
2812 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2813 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2814 been confirmed.
2815
2816 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2817 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
2818 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
2819 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2820
2821 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2822 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2823
2824 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
2825 stats socket.
2826
2827
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002828option allbackups
2829no option allbackups
2830 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
2831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2832 yes | no | yes | yes
2833 Arguments : none
2834
2835 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
2836 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
2837 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
2838 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
2839 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
2840 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
2841 order between the backup servers anymore.
2842
2843 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
2844 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
2845
2846 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2847 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2848
2849
2850option checkcache
2851no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002852 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002853 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2854 yes | no | yes | yes
2855 Arguments : none
2856
2857 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
2858 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002859 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002860 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
2861 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
2862 some sensible session information go in the wild.
2863
2864 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002865 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002866 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002867 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
2868 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002869 to the client are :
2870 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002871 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002872 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002873 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
2874 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
2875 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
2876 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
2877 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
2878 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
2879 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
2880 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
2881 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
2882 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
2883 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
2884
2885 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002886 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002887 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002888 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002889 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
2890
2891 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
2892 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002893 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002894 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
2895
2896 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2897 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2898
2899
2900option clitcpka
2901no option clitcpka
2902 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
2903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2904 yes | yes | yes | no
2905 Arguments : none
2906
2907 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
2908 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
2909 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
2910 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
2911
2912 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
2913 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
2914 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
2915 operating system and its tuning parameters.
2916
2917 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
2918 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
2919 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
2920 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
2921 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
2922
2923 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
2924
2925 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
2926 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
2927 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
2928
2929 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2930 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2931
2932 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
2933
2934
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002935option contstats
2936 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
2937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2938 yes | yes | yes | no
2939 Arguments : none
2940
2941 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
2942 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
2943 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
2944 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
2945 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
2946 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
2947 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
2948
2949
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02002950option dontlog-normal
2951no option dontlog-normal
2952 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
2953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2954 yes | yes | yes | no
2955 Arguments : none
2956
2957 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
2958 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
2959 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
2960 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
2961 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
2962 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
2963 logged.
2964
2965 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
2966 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
2967 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
2968
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002969 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02002970 logging.
2971
2972
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002973option dontlognull
2974no option dontlognull
2975 Enable or disable logging of null connections
2976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2977 yes | yes | yes | no
2978 Arguments : none
2979
2980 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
2981 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
2982 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
2983 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
2984 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
2985 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
2986 which typically corresponds to those probes.
2987
2988 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
2989 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
2990 would not be logged.
2991
2992 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2993 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2994
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002995 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002996
2997
2998option forceclose
2999no option forceclose
3000 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003002 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003003 Arguments : none
3004
3005 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3006 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3007 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3008 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3009 global session times in the logs.
3010
3011 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003012 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003013 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3014 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3015 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3016 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003017
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003018 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3019 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3020 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3021
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003022 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3023 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3024
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003025 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003026
3027
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003028option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003029 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3031 yes | yes | yes | yes
3032 Arguments :
3033 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3034 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003035 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003036 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003037
3038 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3039 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3040 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3041 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3042 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3043 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3044 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003045 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3046 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3047 possible that the client has already brought one.
3048
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003049 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003050 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003051 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3052 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003053 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3054 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003055
3056 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3057 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3058 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3059 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3060 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3061 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3062 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3063
3064 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003065 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3066 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3067 both are defined.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003068
3069 It is important to note that as long as HAProxy does not support keep-alive
3070 connections, only the first request of a connection will receive the header.
3071 For this reason, it is important to ensure that "option httpclose" is set
3072 when using this option.
3073
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003074 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003075 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3076 frontend www
3077 mode http
3078 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3079
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003080 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3081 backend www
3082 mode http
3083 option forwardfor header X-Client
3084
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003085 See also : "option httpclose"
3086
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003087
3088option http-pretend-keepalive
3089no option http-pretend-keepalive
3090 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3092 yes | yes | yes | yes
3093 Arguments : none
3094
3095 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3096 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3097 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3098 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3099 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3100 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3101 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3102 consider the response complete.
3103
3104 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3105 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3106 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3107 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3108 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3109 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3110
3111 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3112 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3113 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3114 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3115 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3116 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3117 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3118
3119 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3120 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003121 This option may be compbined with "option httpclose", which will cause
3122 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3123 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003124
3125 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3126 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3127
3128 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3129
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003130
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003131option http-server-close
3132no option http-server-close
3133 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3135 yes | yes | yes | yes
3136 Arguments : none
3137
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003138 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3139 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3140 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3141 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3142 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3143 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3144 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3145 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3146 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3147 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3148 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3149 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003150
3151 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3152 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3153 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3154 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003155 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3156 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003157
3158 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3159 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003160 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3161 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3162 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003163
3164 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3165 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3166
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003167 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3168 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003169
3170
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003171option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003172no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003173 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3175 yes | yes | yes | no
3176 Arguments : none
3177
3178 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3179 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3180 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3181 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3182 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3183 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3184 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3185
3186 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3187 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3188 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3189 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3190 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3191 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3192 request along its whole life.
3193
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003194 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3195 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3196 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3197 front of an existing proxy.
3198
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003199 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3200
3201 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3202 http-server-close".
3203
3204
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003205option httpchk
3206option httpchk <uri>
3207option httpchk <method> <uri>
3208option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3209 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3211 yes | no | yes | yes
3212 Arguments :
3213 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3214 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3215 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3216 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3217 ones.
3218
3219 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3220 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3221 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3222
3223 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3224 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3225 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3226 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3227 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3228
3229 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3230 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3231 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3232 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3233 the lack of any response.
3234
3235 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3236
3237 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3238 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3239 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3240
3241 Examples :
3242 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3243 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3244 backend https_relay
3245 mode tcp
3246 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3247 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3248
3249 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
3250 "http-check" and the "check", "port" and "inter" server options.
3251
3252
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003253option httpclose
3254no option httpclose
3255 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3257 yes | yes | yes | yes
3258 Arguments : none
3259
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003260 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3261 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3262 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3263 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3264 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3265 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3266 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003267
3268 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003269 close the connection eventhough they reply "Connection: close". For this
3270 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3271 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3272 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3273 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3274 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003275
3276 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3277 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3278 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003279 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3280 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003281
3282 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3283 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3284
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003285 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3286 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003287
3288
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003289option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003290 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3292 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003293 Arguments :
3294 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3295 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3296 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3297 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3298 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003299
3300 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3301 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3302 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3303 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3304 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3305 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3306 ports.
3307
3308 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3309
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003310 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3311 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3312 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3313 by default.
3314
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003315 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003316
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003317
3318option http_proxy
3319no option http_proxy
3320 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3322 yes | yes | yes | yes
3323 Arguments : none
3324
3325 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3326 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3327 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3328 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3329 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3330
3331 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3332 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3333 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3334 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003335 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003336 be analyzed.
3337
3338 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3339 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3340
3341 Example :
3342 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3343 backend direct_forward
3344 option httpclose
3345 option http_proxy
3346
3347 See also : "option httpclose"
3348
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003349
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003350option independant-streams
3351no option independant-streams
3352 Enable or disable independant timeout processing for both directions
3353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3354 yes | yes | yes | yes
3355 Arguments : none
3356
3357 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3358 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3359 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3360 receive data or not.
3361
3362 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3363 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3364 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3365 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3366 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3367 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3368 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3369 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3370 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3371 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3372 socket buffers.
3373
3374 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3375 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3376 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3377 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3378 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3379
3380 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout server"
3381
3382
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003383option ldap-check
3384 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3386 yes | no | yes | yes
3387 Arguments : none
3388
3389 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3390 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3391 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3392 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3393
3394 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3395 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3396
3397 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3398 configure it.
3399
3400 Example :
3401 option ldap-check
3402
3403 See also : "option httpchk"
3404
3405
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003406option log-health-checks
3407no option log-health-checks
3408 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3410 yes | no | yes | yes
3411 Arguments : none
3412
3413 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3414 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3415 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3416 of additional information is limited.
3417
3418 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3419 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3420
3421 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3422
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003423
3424option log-separate-errors
3425no option log-separate-errors
3426 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3428 yes | yes | yes | no
3429 Arguments : none
3430
3431 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3432 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3433 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3434 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3435 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3436 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3437 provides very important information.
3438
3439 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3440 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3441 error logs.
3442
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003443 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003444 logging.
3445
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003446
3447option logasap
3448no option logasap
3449 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3451 yes | yes | yes | no
3452 Arguments : none
3453
3454 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3455 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3456 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3457 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3458 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3459 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3460 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003461 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003462 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3463 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3464
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003465 Examples :
3466 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3467 mode http
3468 option httplog
3469 option logasap
3470 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3471
3472 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3473 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3474 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3475 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3476
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003477 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003478 logging.
3479
3480
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003481option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3482 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3484 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003485 Arguments :
3486 user <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting
3487 to MySQL server.
3488
3489 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3490 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3491 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3492 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3493 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3494 in the MySQL table, like this :
3495
3496 USE mysql;
3497 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3498 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3499
3500 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3501 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3502 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3503 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3504 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3505 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3506 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3507 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3508 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3509
3510 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3511 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003512
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003513 The check requires MySQL >=4.0, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003514
3515 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3516 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3517 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3518 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3519 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3520 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3521
3522 See also: "option httpchk"
3523
3524
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003525option nolinger
3526no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003527 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003528 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3529 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003530 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003531
3532 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3533 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3534 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3535 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3536 connections.
3537
3538 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3539 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3540 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3541 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3542 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3543 this too.
3544
3545 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3546 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3547 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3548
3549 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3550 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3551 for servers.
3552
3553 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3554 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3555
3556
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003557option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3558 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3560 yes | yes | yes | yes
3561 Arguments :
3562 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3563 matching <network>
3564 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3565 header name.
3566
3567 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3568 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3569 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3570 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3571 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3572 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3573 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3574 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3575 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3576 possible that the client has already brought one.
3577
3578 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3579 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3580 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3581 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3582 header and requires different one.
3583
3584 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3585 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3586 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3587 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3588 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3589 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3590 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3591
3592 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3593 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3594 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3595 both are defined.
3596
3597 It is important to note that as long as HAProxy does not support keep-alive
3598 connections, only the first request of a connection will receive the header.
3599 For this reason, it is important to ensure that "option httpclose" is set
3600 when using this option.
3601
3602 Examples :
3603 # Original Destination address
3604 frontend www
3605 mode http
3606 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3607
3608 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3609 backend www
3610 mode http
3611 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3612
3613 See also : "option httpclose"
3614
3615
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003616option persist
3617no option persist
3618 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3619 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3620 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003621 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003622
3623 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3624 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3625 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3626 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3627 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3628 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3629 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3630 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3631 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3632 redirected to another valid server.
3633
3634 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3635 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3636
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003637 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003638
3639
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003640option redispatch
3641no option redispatch
3642 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3643 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3644 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003645 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003646
3647 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3648 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3649 be able to access the service anymore.
3650
3651 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3652 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3653
3654 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3655 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3656 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003657
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003658 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3659 "redisp" keywords.
3660
3661 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3662 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3663
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003664 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003665
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003666
3667option smtpchk
3668option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3669 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3670 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3671 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003672 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003673 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3674 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3675 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3676
3677 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3678 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3679 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3680
3681 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3682 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3683 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3684 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3685 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3686 dead server.
3687
3688 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3689 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3690 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3691 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3692
3693 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3694 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3695 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3696 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3697 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
3698
3699 Example :
3700 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
3701
3702 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
3703
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003704
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02003705option socket-stats
3706no option socket-stats
3707
3708 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
3709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3710 yes | yes | yes | no
3711
3712 Arguments : none
3713
3714
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003715option splice-auto
3716no option splice-auto
3717 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
3718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3719 yes | yes | yes | yes
3720 Arguments : none
3721
3722 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3723 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
3724 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
3725 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003726 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003727 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
3728 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
3729 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
3730 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3731
3732 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
3733 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
3734 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
3735 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
3736 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
3737 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
3738 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
3739 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
3740 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
3741 keyword.
3742
3743 Example :
3744 option splice-auto
3745
3746 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3747 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3748
3749 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
3750 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3751
3752
3753option splice-request
3754no option splice-request
3755 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
3756 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3757 yes | yes | yes | yes
3758 Arguments : none
3759
3760 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3761 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3762 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3763 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3764 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3765 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3766
3767 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3768
3769 Example :
3770 option splice-request
3771
3772 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3773 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3774
3775 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
3776 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3777
3778
3779option splice-response
3780no option splice-response
3781 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
3782 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3783 yes | yes | yes | yes
3784 Arguments : none
3785
3786 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3787 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3788 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3789 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3790 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3791 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3792
3793 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3794
3795 Example :
3796 option splice-response
3797
3798 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3799 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3800
3801 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
3802 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3803
3804
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003805option srvtcpka
3806no option srvtcpka
3807 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
3808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3809 yes | no | yes | yes
3810 Arguments : none
3811
3812 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3813 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3814 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3815 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3816
3817 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3818 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3819 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3820 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3821
3822 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3823 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3824 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3825 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3826 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3827
3828 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3829
3830 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3831 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3832 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
3833
3834 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3835 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3836
3837 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
3838
3839
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003840option ssl-hello-chk
3841 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
3842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3843 yes | no | yes | yes
3844 Arguments : none
3845
3846 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
3847 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
3848 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
3849 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
3850 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
3851 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
3852 hello message.
3853
3854 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
3855 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
3856 messages, which is appreciable.
3857
3858 See also: "option httpchk"
3859
3860
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02003861option tcp-smart-accept
3862no option tcp-smart-accept
3863 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
3864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3865 yes | yes | yes | no
3866 Arguments : none
3867
3868 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
3869 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
3870 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
3871 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
3872 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
3873 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
3874
3875 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
3876 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
3877 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
3878 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
3879
3880 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
3881 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
3882 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
3883 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
3884
3885 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
3886 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
3887 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
3888
3889 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
3890 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
3891 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
3892
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02003893 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
3894
3895
3896option tcp-smart-connect
3897no option tcp-smart-connect
3898 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
3899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3900 yes | no | yes | yes
3901 Arguments : none
3902
3903 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
3904 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
3905 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
3906 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
3907 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
3908
3909 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
3910 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
3911 complex.
3912
3913 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
3914 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
3915 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
3916
3917 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3918 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3919
3920 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
3921
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02003922
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003923option tcpka
3924 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
3925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3926 yes | yes | yes | yes
3927 Arguments : none
3928
3929 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3930 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3931 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3932 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3933
3934 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3935 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3936 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3937 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3938
3939 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3940 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3941 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3942 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3943 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3944
3945 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3946
3947 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
3948 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
3949 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
3950 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
3951 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
3952 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
3953 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
3954 backends.
3955
3956 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
3957
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003958
3959option tcplog
3960 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
3961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3962 yes | yes | yes | yes
3963 Arguments : none
3964
3965 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3966 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3967 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
3968 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
3969 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
3970 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
3971 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
3972 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
3973
3974 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3975
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003976 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003977
3978
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003979option transparent
3980no option transparent
3981 Enable client-side transparent proxying
3982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01003983 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003984 Arguments : none
3985
3986 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
3987 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
3988 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
3989 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
3990 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
3991 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
3992 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
3993 appropriate server.
3994
3995 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
3996 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
3997
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003998 See also: the "usersrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
3999 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004000
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004001
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004002persist rdp-cookie
4003persist rdp-cookie(name)
4004 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4006 yes | no | yes | yes
4007 Arguments :
4008 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004009 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4010 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004011
4012 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4013 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4014 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4015 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4016 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4017 forwarded to this server.
4018
4019 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4020 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4021 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004022 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004023 a single "listen" section.
4024
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004025 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4026 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4027 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4028
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004029 Example :
4030 listen tse-farm
4031 bind :3389
4032 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4033 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4034 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4035 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4036 persist rdp-cookie
4037 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
4038 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
4039 balance rdp-cookie
4040 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4041 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4042
4043 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
4044
4045
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004046rate-limit sessions <rate>
4047 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4049 yes | yes | yes | no
4050 Arguments :
4051 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4052 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4053
4054 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4055 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4056 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4057 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4058 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4059 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4060
4061 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4062 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4063 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4064 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4065
4066 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4067 listen smtp
4068 mode tcp
4069 bind :25
4070 rate-limit sessions 10
4071 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4072
4073 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status appears as
4074 "FULL" in the statistics, exactly as when it is saturated.
4075
4076 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4077
4078
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004079redirect location <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4080redirect prefix <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004081 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4082 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4083 no | yes | yes | yes
4084
4085 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004086 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004087
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004088 Arguments :
4089 <to> With "redirect location", the exact value in <to> is placed into
4090 the HTTP "Location" header. In case of "redirect prefix", the
4091 "Location" header is built from the concatenation of <to> and the
4092 complete URI, including the query string, unless the "drop-query"
Willy Tarreaufe651a52008-11-19 21:15:17 +01004093 option is specified (see below). As a special case, if <to>
4094 equals exactly "/" in prefix mode, then nothing is inserted
4095 before the original URI. It allows one to redirect to the same
4096 URL.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004097
4098 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4099 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4100 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4101 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4102 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4103 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4104 location with a GET method.
4105
4106 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4107 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4108
4109 - "drop-query"
4110 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4111 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4112 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4113 with a location-type redirect.
4114
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004115 - "append-slash"
4116 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4117 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4118 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4119 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4120
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004121 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4122 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4123 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4124 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4125 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4126 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4127 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4128
4129 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4130 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4131 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4132 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4133 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4134 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4135 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004136
4137 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4138 acl clear dst_port 80
4139 acl secure dst_port 8080
4140 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004141 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004142 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004143 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4144
4145 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004146 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4147 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4148 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004149 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004150
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004151 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4152 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4153 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4154
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004155 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004156
4157
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004158redisp (deprecated)
4159redispatch (deprecated)
4160 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4161 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4162 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004163 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004164
4165 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4166 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4167 be able to access the service anymore.
4168
4169 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4170 redistribute them to a working server.
4171
4172 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4173 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4174 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004175
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004176 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4177 "option redispatch" instead.
4178
4179 See also : "option redispatch"
4180
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004181
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004182reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004183 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4185 no | yes | yes | yes
4186 Arguments :
4187 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4188 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004189 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004190
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004191 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4192 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4193
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004194 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4195 the last header of an HTTP request.
4196
4197 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4198 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4199 responses.
4200
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004201 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4202 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4203 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4204
4205 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4206 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004207
4208
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004209reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4210reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004211 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4213 no | yes | yes | yes
4214 Arguments :
4215 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4216 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4217 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4218 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4219 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4220 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4221 ignores case.
4222
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004223 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4224 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4225
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004226 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4227 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4228 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4229 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004230 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004231
4232 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4233 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4234
4235 Example :
4236 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4237 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4238 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4239
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004240 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4241 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004242
4243
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004244reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4245reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004246 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4248 no | yes | yes | yes
4249 Arguments :
4250 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4251 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4252 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4253 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4254 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4255 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4256
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004257 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4258 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4259
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004260 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4261 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4262 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4263 next servers.
4264
4265 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4266 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4267 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4268
4269 Example :
4270 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4271 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4272 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4273
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004274 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4275 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004276
4277
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004278reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4279reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004280 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4282 no | yes | yes | yes
4283 Arguments :
4284 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4285 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4286 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4287 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4288 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4289 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4290 case.
4291
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004292 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4293 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4294
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004295 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4296 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4297 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4298 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004299 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004300
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004301 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004302 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004303 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004304
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004305 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4306 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4307
4308 Example :
4309 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4310 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4311 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4312
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004313 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4314 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004315
4316
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004317reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4318reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004319 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4321 no | yes | yes | yes
4322 Arguments :
4323 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4324 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4325 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4326 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4327 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4328 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4329 case.
4330
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004331 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4332 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4333
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004334 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4335 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4336 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4337 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4338
4339 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4340 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4341
4342 Example :
4343 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4344 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4345 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4346 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4347
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004348 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4349 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004350
4351
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004352reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4353reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004354 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4356 no | yes | yes | yes
4357 Arguments :
4358 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4359 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4360 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4361 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4362 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4363 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4364
4365 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4366 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4367 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4368 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004369 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004370
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004371 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4372 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4373
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004374 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4375 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4376 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4377
4378 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4379 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4380 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4381 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4382 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4383
4384 Example :
4385 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
4386 reqrep ^([^\ ]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
4387 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4388 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4389
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004390 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", section 6 about HTTP header
4391 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004392
4393
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004394reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4395reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004396 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4398 no | yes | yes | yes
4399 Arguments :
4400 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4401 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4402 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4403 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4404 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4405 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4406 ignores case.
4407
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004408 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4409 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4410
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004411 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4412 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004413 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4414 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4415 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004416 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4417 not set.
4418
4419 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4420 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4421 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4422 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4423 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4424
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004425 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004426 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4427 # block all others.
4428 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4429 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4430
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004431 # block bad guys
4432 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4433 reqitarpit . if badguys
4434
4435 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4436 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004437
4438
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004439retries <value>
4440 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4441 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4442 yes | no | yes | yes
4443 Arguments :
4444 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4445 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4446 default value is 3.
4447
4448 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4449 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4450 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4451
4452 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4453 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4454
4455 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4456 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4457
4458 See also : "option redispatch"
4459
4460
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004461rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004462 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4464 no | yes | yes | yes
4465 Arguments :
4466 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4467 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004468 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004469
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004470 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4471 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4472
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004473 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4474 the last header of an HTTP response.
4475
4476 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4477 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4478 responses.
4479
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004480 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4481 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004482
4483
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004484rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4485rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004486 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4488 no | yes | yes | yes
4489 Arguments :
4490 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4491 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4492 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4493 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4494 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4495 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4496 ignores case.
4497
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004498 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4499 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4500
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004501 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4502 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4503 and/or sensible headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
4504 client.
4505
4506 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4507 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4508 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4509
4510 Example :
4511 # remove the Server header from responses
4512 reqidel ^Server:.*
4513
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004514 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4515 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004516
4517
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004518rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4519rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004520 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4522 no | yes | yes | yes
4523 Arguments :
4524 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4525 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4526 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4527 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4528 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4529 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4530 ignores case.
4531
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004532 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4533 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4534
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004535 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4536 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4537 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4538 case-sensitive.
4539
4540 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004541 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4542 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4543 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004544
4545 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4546 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4547
4548 Example :
4549 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4550 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4551
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004552 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4553 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004554
4555
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004556rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4557rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004558 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4560 no | yes | yes | yes
4561 Arguments :
4562 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4563 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4564 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4565 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4566 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4567 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4568 ignores case.
4569
4570 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4571 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4572 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4573 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004574 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004575
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004576 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4577 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4578
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004579 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4580 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4581 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4582
4583 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4584 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4585 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4586 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4587 are not case-sensitive.
4588
4589 Example :
4590 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4591 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4592
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004593 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4594 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004595
4596
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004597server <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
4598 Declare a server in a backend
4599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4600 no | no | yes | yes
4601 Arguments :
4602 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
4603 appear in logs and alerts.
4604
4605 <address> is the IPv4 address of the server. Alternatively, a resolvable
4606 hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved during
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004607 start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning. It
4608 indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
4609 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4610 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4611 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4612 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4613 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4614 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004615
4616 <ports> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
4617 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4618 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4619 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4620 adding this value to the client's port.
4621
4622 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4623 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004624 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004625
4626 Examples :
4627 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4628 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4629
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004630 See also: "default-server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004631
4632
4633source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004634source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004635source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004636 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4638 yes | no | yes | yes
4639 Arguments :
4640 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4641 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4642 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4643 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4644
4645 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4646 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004647 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4648 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4649 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004650
4651 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4652 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4653 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4654 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4655 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4656 <addr>.
4657
4658 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4659 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4660 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4661 port.
4662
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004663 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4664 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4665 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4666 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4667 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4668 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4669 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4670 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4671 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4672 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4673 HTTP header.
4674
4675 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4676 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
4677 in order to specificy which occurrence to use for the source IP
4678 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4679 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4680 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
4681 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
4682 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
4683 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
4684 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
4685
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004686 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
4687 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
4688 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
4689 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
4690 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
4691 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
4692
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004693 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
4694 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
4695 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
4696 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
4697
4698 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
4699 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
4700 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
4701 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
4702 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
4703 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
4704
4705 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
4706 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
4707 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
4708 there are two methods :
4709
4710 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
4711 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
4712 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
4713 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
4714 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
4715 of the client ranges may be used.
4716
4717 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
4718 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
4719 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
4720 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
4721 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
4722 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
4723 same session.
4724
4725 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
4726 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
4727 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
4728 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
4729 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
4730 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
4731
4732 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
4733 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
4734 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004735 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004736
4737 Examples :
4738 backend private
4739 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
4740 source 192.168.1.200
4741
4742 backend transparent_ssl1
4743 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
4744 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4745
4746 backend transparent_ssl2
4747 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
4748 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
4749 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
4750
4751 backend transparent_ssl3
4752 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
4753 # is more conntrack-friendly.
4754 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4755
4756 backend transparent_smtp
4757 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
4758 # with Tproxy version 4.
4759 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
4760
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004761 backend transparent_http
4762 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
4763 # proxy.
4764 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
4765
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004766 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004767 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
4768
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004769
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004770srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
4771 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
4772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4773 yes | no | yes | yes
4774 Arguments :
4775 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4776 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4777 as explained at the top of this document.
4778
4779 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
4780 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
4781 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
4782 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
4783 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
4784 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
4785 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
4786
4787 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
4788 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
4789 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
4790 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
4791 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004792 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004793 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004794 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004795
4796 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
4797 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
4798 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
4799 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
4800 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
4801 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
4802
4803 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
4804 Please use "timeout server" instead.
4805
4806 See also : "timeout server", "timeout client" and "clitimeout".
4807
4808
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004809stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
4810 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
4811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4812 no | no | yes | yes
4813
4814 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
4815 matched.
4816
4817 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
4818 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
4819
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01004820 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
4821 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
4822 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
4823
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004824 Currently, there are 2 known limitations :
4825
4826 - The POST data are limited to one packet, which means that if the list of
4827 servers is too long, the request won't be processed. It is recommended
4828 to alter few servers at a time.
4829
4830 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported.
4831
4832 Example :
4833 # statistics admin level only for localhost
4834 backend stats_localhost
4835 stats enable
4836 stats admin if LOCALHOST
4837
4838 Example :
4839 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
4840 backend stats_auth
4841 stats enable
4842 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
4843 stats admin if TRUE
4844
4845 Example :
4846 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
4847 userlist stats-auth
4848 group admin users admin
4849 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
4850 group readonly users haproxy
4851 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
4852
4853 backend stats_auth
4854 stats enable
4855 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
4856 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
4857 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
4858 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
4859
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01004860 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
4861 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4862 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004863
4864
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004865stats auth <user>:<passwd>
4866 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
4867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4868 yes | no | yes | yes
4869 Arguments :
4870 <user> is a user name to grant access to
4871
4872 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
4873
4874 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
4875 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
4876 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
4877 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
4878 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
4879 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
4880
4881 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
4882 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
4883 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
4884 that those ones should not be sensible and not shared with any other account.
4885
4886 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
4887 report using "stats scope".
4888
4889 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4890 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4891 unobvious parameters.
4892
4893 Example :
4894 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4895 backend public_www
4896 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4897 stats enable
4898 stats hide-version
4899 stats scope .
4900 stats uri /admin?stats
4901 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4902 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4903 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
4904
4905 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4906 backend private_monitoring
4907 stats enable
4908 stats uri /admin?stats
4909 stats refresh 5s
4910
4911 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
4912
4913
4914stats enable
4915 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
4916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4917 yes | no | yes | yes
4918 Arguments : none
4919
4920 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
4921 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
4922 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
4923 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
4924 - stats auth : no authentication
4925 - stats scope : no restriction
4926
4927 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4928 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4929 unobvious parameters.
4930
4931 Example :
4932 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4933 backend public_www
4934 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4935 stats enable
4936 stats hide-version
4937 stats scope .
4938 stats uri /admin?stats
4939 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4940 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4941 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
4942
4943 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4944 backend private_monitoring
4945 stats enable
4946 stats uri /admin?stats
4947 stats refresh 5s
4948
4949 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
4950
4951
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004952stats hide-version
4953 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4955 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004956 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004957
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004958 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
4959 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
4960 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
4961 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
4962 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
4963 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004964
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02004965 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4966 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4967 unobvious parameters.
4968
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004969 Example :
4970 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4971 backend public_www
4972 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02004973 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004974 stats hide-version
4975 stats scope .
4976 stats uri /admin?stats
4977 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4978 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4979 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004980
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004981 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4982 backend private_monitoring
4983 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004984 stats uri /admin?stats
4985 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01004986
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004987 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004988
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004989
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004990stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
4991 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4992 Access control for statistics
4993
4994 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4995 no | no | yes | yes
4996
4997 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
4998 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
4999 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5000 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5001 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5002 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5003
5004 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5005 instance.
5006
5007 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5008 about ACL usage.
5009
5010
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005011stats realm <realm>
5012 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5014 yes | no | yes | yes
5015 Arguments :
5016 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5017 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5018 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5019
5020 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5021 using a backslash ('\').
5022
5023 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5024 only related to authentication.
5025
5026 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5027 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5028 unobvious parameters.
5029
5030 Example :
5031 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5032 backend public_www
5033 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5034 stats enable
5035 stats hide-version
5036 stats scope .
5037 stats uri /admin?stats
5038 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5039 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5040 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5041
5042 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5043 backend private_monitoring
5044 stats enable
5045 stats uri /admin?stats
5046 stats refresh 5s
5047
5048 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5049
5050
5051stats refresh <delay>
5052 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5053 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5054 yes | no | yes | yes
5055 Arguments :
5056 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5057 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5058 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5059 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5060 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5061 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5062
5063 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5064 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5065 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5066 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5067
5068 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5069 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5070 unobvious parameters.
5071
5072 Example :
5073 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5074 backend public_www
5075 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5076 stats enable
5077 stats hide-version
5078 stats scope .
5079 stats uri /admin?stats
5080 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5081 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5082 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5083
5084 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5085 backend private_monitoring
5086 stats enable
5087 stats uri /admin?stats
5088 stats refresh 5s
5089
5090 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5091
5092
5093stats scope { <name> | "." }
5094 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5096 yes | no | yes | yes
5097 Arguments :
5098 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5099 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5100 section in which the statement appears.
5101
5102 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5103 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5104 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5105 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5106 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5107 exists.
5108
5109 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5110 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5111 unobvious parameters.
5112
5113 Example :
5114 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5115 backend public_www
5116 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5117 stats enable
5118 stats hide-version
5119 stats scope .
5120 stats uri /admin?stats
5121 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5122 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5123 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5124
5125 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5126 backend private_monitoring
5127 stats enable
5128 stats uri /admin?stats
5129 stats refresh 5s
5130
5131 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5132
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005133
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005134stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005135 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5137 yes | no | yes | yes
5138
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005139 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005140 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5141
5142 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5143 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5144
5145 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5146 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5147 unobvious parameters.
5148
5149 Example :
5150 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5151 backend private_monitoring
5152 stats enable
5153 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5154 stats uri /admin?stats
5155 stats refresh 5s
5156
5157 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5158 global section.
5159
5160
5161stats show-legends
5162 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5163 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5164 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5165 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5166 - IP (socket, server)
5167 - cookie (backend, server)
5168
5169 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5170 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5171 unobvious parameters.
5172
5173 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5174
5175
5176stats show-node [ <name> ]
5177 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5179 yes | no | yes | yes
5180 Arguments:
5181 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5182 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5183
5184 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5185 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
5186 provided for each customer.
5187
5188 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5189 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5190 unobvious parameters.
5191
5192 Example:
5193 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5194 backend private_monitoring
5195 stats enable
5196 stats show-node Europe-1
5197 stats uri /admin?stats
5198 stats refresh 5s
5199
5200 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5201 section.
5202
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005203
5204stats uri <prefix>
5205 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5207 yes | no | yes | yes
5208 Arguments :
5209 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5210 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5211 query string.
5212
5213 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5214 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5215 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5216 possible to reach it in the application.
5217
5218 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005219 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005220 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5221 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5222 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5223 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5224
5225 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5226 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5227 an address or a port to statistics only.
5228
5229 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5230 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5231 unobvious parameters.
5232
5233 Example :
5234 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5235 backend public_www
5236 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5237 stats enable
5238 stats hide-version
5239 stats scope .
5240 stats uri /admin?stats
5241 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5242 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5243 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5244
5245 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5246 backend private_monitoring
5247 stats enable
5248 stats uri /admin?stats
5249 stats refresh 5s
5250
5251 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5252
5253
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005254stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5255 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005257 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005258
5259 Arguments :
5260 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5261 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5262 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5263 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5264
5265 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5266 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5267 the "stick-table" statement.
5268
5269 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5270 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5271 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5272 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5273 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5274
5275 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5276 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5277 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5278 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5279 transformation rules.
5280
5281 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5282 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5283 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5284 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5285 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5286 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5287 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5288
5289 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5290 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5291 ACL based conditions.
5292
5293 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5294 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5295 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5296 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5297
5298 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5299 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5300 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5301 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5302
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005303 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5304 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5305 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5306
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005307 Example :
5308 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5309 # last 30 minutes
5310 backend pop
5311 mode tcp
5312 balance roundrobin
5313 stick store-request src
5314 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5315 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5316 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5317
5318 backend smtp
5319 mode tcp
5320 balance roundrobin
5321 stick match src table pop
5322 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5323 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5324
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005325 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5326 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005327
5328
5329stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5330 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5331 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5332 no | no | yes | yes
5333
5334 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5335 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5336 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5337 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5338
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005339 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5340 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5341 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5342
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005343 Examples :
5344 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005345 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005346
5347 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5348 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5349 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5350
5351
5352 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5353 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5354 backend http
5355 mode http
5356 balance roundrobin
5357 stick on src table https
5358 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5359 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5360 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5361
5362 backend https
5363 mode tcp
5364 balance roundrobin
5365 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5366 stick on src
5367 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5368 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5369
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005370 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005371
5372
5373stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5374 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5375 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5376 no | no | yes | yes
5377
5378 Arguments :
5379 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5380 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5381 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5382 server is selected.
5383
5384 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5385 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5386 the "stick-table" statement.
5387
5388 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5389 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5390 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5391 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5392 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5393 address.
5394
5395 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5396 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5397 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5398 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5399 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5400 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5401 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5402 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5403 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5404 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5405
5406 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5407 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5408 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5409 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5410 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5411 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5412 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5413
5414 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5415 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5416 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5417 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5418
5419 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5420 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5421 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5422 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5423 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5424 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5425 another protocol or access method.
5426
5427 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5428 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5429 the request.
5430
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005431 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5432 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5433 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5434
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005435 Example :
5436 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5437 # last 30 minutes
5438 backend pop
5439 mode tcp
5440 balance roundrobin
5441 stick store-request src
5442 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5443 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5444 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5445
5446 backend smtp
5447 mode tcp
5448 balance roundrobin
5449 stick match src table pop
5450 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5451 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5452
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005453 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5454 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005455
5456
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005457stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005458 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5459 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005460 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005462 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005463
5464 Arguments :
5465 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5466 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5467 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5468 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5469
5470 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5471 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5472 instance.
5473
5474 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5475 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5476 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5477 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5478 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5479 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005480 to 32 characters.
5481
5482 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5483 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5484 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5485 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5486 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5487 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005488
5489 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005490 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5491 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005492 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5493 increase.
5494
5495 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005496 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5497 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5498 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005499
5500 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5501 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5502 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5503 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5504 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5505 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5506 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5507 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5508 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5509 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5510 parameter (see below).
5511
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005512 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5513 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5514 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5515 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5516 soft restart.
5517
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005518 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5519
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005520 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5521 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5522 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5523 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5524 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
5525 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
5526 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5527 if not expiration delay is specified.
5528
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005529 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5530 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5531 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5532 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005533 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5534 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5535 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5536 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5537 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5538 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5539 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5540 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5541 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5542 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5543 types and their arguments.
5544
5545 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5546 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5547 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5548 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5549
5550 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5551 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5552 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5553 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5554
5555 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5556 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5557 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5558 they were received.
5559
5560 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5561 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5562 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5563 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5564 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5565
5566 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5567 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5568 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5569 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5570 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5571
5572 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5573 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5574 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5575
5576 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5577 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5578 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5579 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5580 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5581
5582 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5583 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5584 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5585 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5586 the client side.
5587
5588 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5589 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5590 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5591 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5592 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5593 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5594 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5595
5596 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5597 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5598 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5599 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5600 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5601 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5602 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5603
5604 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5605 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5606 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5607 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5608 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5609 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5610
5611 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5612 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5613 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5614 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5615
5616 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5617 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5618 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5619 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5620 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5621 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5622 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5623 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5624 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5625 recommended for better fairness.
5626
5627 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5628 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5629 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5630 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5631
5632 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5633 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5634 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5635 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5636 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5637 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5638 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5639 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5640 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5641 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005642
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005643 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5644 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005645 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5646 reference it.
5647
5648 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5649 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5650 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5651 as an exclusive stickiness.
5652
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005653 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5654 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5655 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5656 something that can be ignored.
5657
5658 Example:
5659 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5660 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5661 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5662 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5663
5664 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
5665 about time format and section 7 avoud ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005666
5667
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005668stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5669 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5670 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5671 no | no | yes | yes
5672
5673 Arguments :
5674 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5675 describes what elements of the response or connection will
5676 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5677 server is selected.
5678
5679 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5680 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5681 the "stick-table" statement.
5682
5683 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5684 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5685 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
5686 when the response is a SSL server hello.
5687
5688 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5689 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
5690 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
5691 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
5692 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
5693 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
5694 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
5695 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
5696 rules.
5697
5698 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5699 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5700 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5701 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5702 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5703 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5704 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5705
5706 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
5707 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5708 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
5709 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5710
5711 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
5712 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5713 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5714 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5715 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5716 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5717 another protocol or access method.
5718
5719 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
5720
5721 Example :
5722 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
5723 backend https
5724 mode tcp
5725 balance roundrobin
5726 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
5727 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
5728
5729 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
5730 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
5731
5732 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
5733 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5734 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
5735
5736 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
5737 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
5738
5739 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
5740 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
5741 # at offset 44.
5742
5743 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
5744 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
5745
5746 # Learn on response if server hello.
5747 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
5748
5749 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5750 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5751
5752 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5753 extraction.
5754
5755
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005756tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5757 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5759 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005760 Arguments :
5761 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5762 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5763 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005764
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005765 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005766
5767 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
5768 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005769 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
5770 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
5771 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
5772 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
5773 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
5774 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005775
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005776 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
5777 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
5778 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
5779 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005780
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005781 Three types of actions are supported :
5782 - accept :
5783 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5784 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5785 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005786
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005787 - reject :
5788 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5789 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5790 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
5791 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
5792 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
5793 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
5794 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
5795 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
5796 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
5797 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
5798 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
5799 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005800
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005801 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
5802 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
5803 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
5804 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
5805 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
5806 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
5807 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
5808 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
5809 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005810
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005811 These actions take one or two arguments :
5812 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
5813 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
5814 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005815
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005816 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
5817 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
5818 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
5819 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005820
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005821 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
5822 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
5823 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
5824 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
5825 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
5826 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
5827 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
5828 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
5829 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
5830 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005831
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005832 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
5833 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
5834 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005835
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005836 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
5837 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
5838 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005839
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005840 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005841 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005842 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005843
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005844 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
5845 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
5846 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005847
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005848 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
5849 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
5850 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005851
5852 See section 7 about ACL usage.
5853
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005854 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005855
5856
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005857tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5858 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02005860 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005861 Arguments :
5862 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5863 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5864 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005865
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005866 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005867
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005868 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
5869 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
5870 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
5871 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
5872 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005873
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005874 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
5875 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
5876 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
5877 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
5878 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
5879 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
5880 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
5881 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
5882 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005883
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005884 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
5885 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
5886 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
5887 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005888
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005889 Three types of actions are supported :
5890 - accept :
5891 - reject :
5892 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005893
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005894 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
5895 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005896
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005897 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
5898 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
5899 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
5900 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
5901 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
5902 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005903
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005904 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005905 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
5906 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005907
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005908 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
5909 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full request has been
5910 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
5911 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
5912 period.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005913
5914 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005915 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
5916 # and reject everything else.
5917 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
5918 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
5919 tcp-request content accept if HTTP is_host_com
5920 tcp-request content reject
5921
5922 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005923 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
5924 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
5925 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005926 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005927
5928 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
5929 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
5930 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005931 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005932 tcp-request content reject
5933
5934 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
5935 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
5936
5937 frontend http
5938 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
5939 # protecting all our sites
5940 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
5941 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
5942 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
5943 ...
5944 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
5945
5946 backend http_dynamic
5947 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
5948 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
5949 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
5950 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
5951 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
5952 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
5953 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005954
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005955 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005956
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005957 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005958
5959
5960tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
5961 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
5962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02005963 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005964 Arguments :
5965 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5966 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5967 as explained at the top of this document.
5968
5969 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
5970 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
5971 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
5972 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
5973 data for at most the specified amount of time.
5974
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02005975 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
5976 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
5977 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
5978 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
5979
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005980 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
5981 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005982 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005983 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01005984 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
5985 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
5986 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
5987 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005988
5989 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
5990 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
5991 it pass through unaffected.
5992
5993 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
5994 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
5995 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005996 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005997 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
5998 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02005999 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6000 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6001 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006002
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006003 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006004 "timeout client".
6005
6006
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006007tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6008 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6010 no | no | yes | yes
6011 Arguments :
6012 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6013 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6014 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6015
6016 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6017
6018 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6019 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6020 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6021 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
6022 set and expires with no matching rule.
6023
6024 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6025
6026 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6027 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6028 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6029 inserted.
6030
6031 Two types of actions are supported :
6032 - accept :
6033 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6034 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6035 the rules evaluation.
6036
6037 - reject :
6038 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6039 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6040 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediatly closed.
6041
6042 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6043 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6044 for changing the default action to a reject.
6045
6046 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-reponse content"
6047 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has been
6048 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
6049 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
6050 period.
6051
6052 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6053
6054 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6055
6056
6057tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6058 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6060 no | no | yes | yes
6061 Arguments :
6062 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6063 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6064 as explained at the top of this document.
6065
6066 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6067
6068
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006069timeout check <timeout>
6070 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6071 established.
6072
6073 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6074 yes | no | yes | yes
6075 Arguments:
6076 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6077 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6078 as explained at the top of this document.
6079
6080 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6081 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6082 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6083 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006084 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6085 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6086 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006087
6088 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6089 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6090
6091 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6092 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006093 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006094
6095 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6096 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6097 forget about it.
6098
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006099 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6100 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006101
6102
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006103timeout client <timeout>
6104timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6105 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6107 yes | yes | yes | no
6108 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006109 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006110 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6111 as explained at the top of this document.
6112
6113 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6114 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6115 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6116 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6117 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6118 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6119 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6120 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006121 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006122 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
6123 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
6124
6125 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6126 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6127 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6128 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6129 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6130 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6131
6132 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6133 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6134 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6135
6136 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server".
6137
6138
6139timeout connect <timeout>
6140timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6141 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6143 yes | no | yes | yes
6144 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006145 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006146 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6147 as explained at the top of this document.
6148
6149 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006150 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006151 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006152 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006153 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6154 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006155
6156 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6157 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6158 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6159 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6160 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6161 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6162
6163 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6164 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6165 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6166
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006167 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6168 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006169
6170
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006171timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6172 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6174 yes | yes | yes | yes
6175 Arguments :
6176 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6177 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6178 as explained at the top of this document.
6179
6180 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6181 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6182 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6183 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6184 once the request has started to present itself.
6185
6186 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6187 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6188 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6189 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6190 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6191
6192 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6193 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6194 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6195 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6196
6197 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6198 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6199 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6200 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6201 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006202 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006203
6204 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6205 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6206 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6207 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6208
6209 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6210
6211
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006212timeout http-request <timeout>
6213 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006215 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006216 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006217 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006218 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6219 as explained at the top of this document.
6220
6221 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6222 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6223 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6224 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6225 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6226 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6227 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6228 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6229
6230 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6231 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006232 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6233 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006234
6235 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6236 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6237 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6238 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6239 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6240
6241 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006242 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6243 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6244 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006245
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006246 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006247
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006248
6249timeout queue <timeout>
6250 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6252 yes | no | yes | yes
6253 Arguments :
6254 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6255 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6256 as explained at the top of this document.
6257
6258 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6259 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6260 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6261 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6262 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6263
6264 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6265 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6266 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6267 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6268
6269 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6270
6271
6272timeout server <timeout>
6273timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6274 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6276 yes | no | yes | yes
6277 Arguments :
6278 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6279 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6280 as explained at the top of this document.
6281
6282 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6283 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6284 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6285 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6286 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6287 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6288 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6289
6290 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6291 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6292 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6293 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6294 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006295 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006296 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006297 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006298
6299 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6300 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6301 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6302 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6303 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6304 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6305
6306 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6307 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6308 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6309
6310 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client".
6311
6312
6313timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006314 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006315 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6316 yes | yes | yes | yes
6317 Arguments :
6318 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6319 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6320 as explained at the top of this document.
6321
6322 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6323 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6324 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6325
6326 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6327 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6328 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6329 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006330 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006331
6332 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6333
6334
6335transparent (deprecated)
6336 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6337 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006338 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006339 Arguments : none
6340
6341 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6342 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6343 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6344 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6345 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6346 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6347 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6348 appropriate server.
6349
6350 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6351
6352 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6353 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6354
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006355 See also: "option transparent"
6356
6357
6358use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6359use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006360 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6362 no | yes | yes | no
6363 Arguments :
6364 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6365
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006366 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006367
6368 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6369 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6370 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006371 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6372 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6373 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6374 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006375
6376 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6377 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6378 assign the backend.
6379
6380 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6381 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6382 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6383 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6384 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6385 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6386
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006387 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006388 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006389 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6390 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6391 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6392
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006393 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006394
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006395
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010063965. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006397------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006398
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006399The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
6400which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
6401arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
6402settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
6403after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
6404Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
6405address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006406
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006407 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006408 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006409
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006410The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006411
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006412addr <ipv4>
6413 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
6414 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
6415 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
6416 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
6417 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006418
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006419 Supported in default-server: No
6420
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006421backup
6422 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
6423 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
6424 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
6425 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
6426 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
6427 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006428
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006429 Supported in default-server: No
6430
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006431check
6432 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
6433 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server will receive
6434 periodic health checks to ensure that it is really able to serve requests.
6435 The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the server,
6436 and the default source is the same as the one defined in the backend. It is
6437 possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the port using the
6438 "port" parameter, the source address using the "source" address, and the
6439 interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall" parameters. The
6440 request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk", "smtpchk",
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006441 "mysql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please refer to those options and
6442 parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006443
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006444 Supported in default-server: No
6445
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006446cookie <value>
6447 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
6448 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
6449 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
6450 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
6451 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
6452 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
6453 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
6454
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006455 Supported in default-server: No
6456
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02006457disabled
6458 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
6459 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
6460 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
6461 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
6462 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
6463
6464 Supported in default-server: No
6465
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006466error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006467 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
6468 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
6469 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006470
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006471 Supported in default-server: Yes
6472
6473 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006474
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006475fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006476 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
6477 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
6478 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
6479
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006480 Supported in default-server: Yes
6481
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006482id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006483 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
6484 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
6485 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006486
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006487 Supported in default-server: No
6488
6489inter <delay>
6490fastinter <delay>
6491downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006492 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
6493 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
6494 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
6495 between checks depending on the server state :
6496
6497 Server state | Interval used
6498 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6499 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
6500 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6501 Transitionally UP (going down), |
6502 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6503 or yet unchecked. |
6504 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6505 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6506 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006507
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006508 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
6509 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
6510 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
6511 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
6512 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
6513 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
6514 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
6515 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
6516 servers.
6517
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006518 Supported in default-server: Yes
6519
6520maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006521 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
6522 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
6523 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
6524 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
6525 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
6526 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
6527 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
6528 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
6529
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006530 Supported in default-server: Yes
6531
6532maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006533 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
6534 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
6535 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
6536 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
6537 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
6538 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
6539 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
6540
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006541 Supported in default-server: Yes
6542
6543minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006544 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
6545 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
6546 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
6547 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
6548 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
6549 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006550 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006551 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006552
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006553 Supported in default-server: Yes
6554
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006555observe <mode>
6556 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
6557 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
6558 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
6559 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
6560 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
6561 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
6562 headers, a timeout, etc.
6563
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006564 Supported in default-server: No
6565
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006566 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
6567
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006568on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006569 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
6570 Currently, four modes are available:
6571 - fastinter: force fastinter
6572 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
6573 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
6574 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
6575 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
6576
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006577 Supported in default-server: Yes
6578
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006579 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
6580
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006581port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006582 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
6583 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
6584 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
6585 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
6586 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
6587 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
6588
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006589 Supported in default-server: Yes
6590
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006591redir <prefix>
6592 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
6593 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
6594 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
6595 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
6596 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
6597 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
6598 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
6599 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006600 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006601 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
6602 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
6603 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
6604 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
6605 loop between the client and HAProxy!
6606
6607 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
6608
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006609 Supported in default-server: No
6610
6611rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006612 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
6613 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
6614 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
6615
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006616 Supported in default-server: Yes
6617
6618slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006619 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
6620 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
6621 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
6622 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
6623 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
6624 parameters :
6625
6626 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
6627 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
6628
6629 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
6630 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
6631 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
6632 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
6633
6634 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
6635 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
6636 seen as failed.
6637
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006638 Supported in default-server: Yes
6639
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006640source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006641source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006642source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006643 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
6644 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
6645 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
6646 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
6647
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006648 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
6649 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
6650 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
6651 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
6652 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
6653 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
6654 server.
6655
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006656 Supported in default-server: No
6657
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006658track [<proxy>/]<server>
6659 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
6660 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
6661 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
6662 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
6663 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
6664
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006665 Supported in default-server: No
6666
6667weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006668 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
6669 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
6670 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02006671 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
6672 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
6673 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
6674 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
6675 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
6676 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006677
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006678 Supported in default-server: Yes
6679
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006680
66816. HTTP header manipulation
6682---------------------------
6683
6684In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
6685response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
6686request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
6687which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
6688against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
6689to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
6690passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
6691headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
6692never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
6693
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006694There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
6695(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
6696rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
6697messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
6698in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006699happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006700add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
6701normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
6702
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006703This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
6704in section 4.2 :
6705
6706 - reqadd <string>
6707 - reqallow <search>
6708 - reqiallow <search>
6709 - reqdel <search>
6710 - reqidel <search>
6711 - reqdeny <search>
6712 - reqideny <search>
6713 - reqpass <search>
6714 - reqipass <search>
6715 - reqrep <search> <replace>
6716 - reqirep <search> <replace>
6717 - reqtarpit <search>
6718 - reqitarpit <search>
6719 - rspadd <string>
6720 - rspdel <search>
6721 - rspidel <search>
6722 - rspdeny <search>
6723 - rspideny <search>
6724 - rsprep <search> <replace>
6725 - rspirep <search> <replace>
6726
6727With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
6728is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
6729parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
6730prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
6731Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
6732
6733 \t for a tab
6734 \r for a carriage return (CR)
6735 \n for a new line (LF)
6736 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
6737 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
6738 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
6739 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
6740 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
6741
6742The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
6743portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
6744above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
6745regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
67469 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
6747is very common to users of the "sed" program.
6748
6749The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
6750after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
6751
6752Notes related to these keywords :
6753---------------------------------
6754 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
6755 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
6756 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
6757
6758 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
6759 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
6760 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
6761
6762 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
6763 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
6764 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
6765 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
6766 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
6767
6768 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
6769 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
6770 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
6771 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
6772 useless headers before adding new ones.
6773
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006774 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006775 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
6776
6777 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
6778 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
6779 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
6780
6781 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
6782 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006783 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006784
6785
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010067867. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
6787------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006788
6789The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
6790content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
6791from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
6792simple :
6793
6794 - define test criteria with sets of values
6795 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
6796
6797The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
6798
6799In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
6800
6801 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
6802
6803This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
6804Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
6805and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
6806an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
6807of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
6808
6809ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
6810'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
6811which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
6812
6813There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
6814performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
6815
6816The following ACL flags are currently supported :
6817
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006818 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
6819 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006820 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
6821
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006822The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
6823specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
6824possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02006825multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
6826be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
6827needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
6828space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
6829match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
6830lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
6831duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
6832to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceeding it. For
6833instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006834
6835 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
6836
6837In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
6838the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
6839case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
6840too.
6841
6842Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
6843a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
6844ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
6845
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006846Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006847
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006848 - integers or integer ranges
6849 - strings
6850 - regular expressions
6851 - IP addresses and networks
6852
6853
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020068547.1. Matching integers
6855----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006856
6857Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
6858that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
6859expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
6860may be omitted.
6861
6862For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
6863unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
6864representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
6865
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006866As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
6867two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
6868instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
6869ranges and operators.
6870
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006871For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006872operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
6873Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
6874of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006875
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006876Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006877
6878 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
6879 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
6880 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
6881 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
6882 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
6883
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006884For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006885
6886 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
6887
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006888This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
6889
6890 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
6891
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006892
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020068937.2. Matching strings
6894---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006895
6896String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
6897exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
6898characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
6899string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
6900to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006901before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006902
6903
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069047.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
6905-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006906
6907Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
6908they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
6909possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
6910passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
6911the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006912the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
6913match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006914
6915
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069167.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
6917----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006918
6919IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
6920netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
6921within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006922host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006923difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
6924at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
6925does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
6926parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006927
6928
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069297.5. Available matching criteria
6930--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006931
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069327.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
6933------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006934
6935A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
6936analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
6937addresses and ports, as well as internal values independant on the stream.
6938
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006939always_false
6940 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
6941 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
6942
6943always_true
6944 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
6945 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
6946
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006947avg_queue <integer>
Willy Tarreau6cbd6472010-09-08 19:06:18 +02006948avg_queue(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006949 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
6950 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
6951 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
6952 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
6953 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
6954 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
6955 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
6956 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
6957 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
6958 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
6959 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01006960
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006961be_conn <integer>
Willy Tarreau6cbd6472010-09-08 19:06:18 +02006962be_conn(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006963 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
6964 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
6965 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
6966 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
6967 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006968
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01006969be_id <integer>
6970 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
6971 backend it was called.
6972
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006973be_sess_rate <integer>
6974be_sess_rate(backend) <integer>
6975 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
6976 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
6977 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
6978 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
6979 sucking of an online dictionary).
6980
6981 Example :
6982 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
6983 backend dynamic
6984 mode http
6985 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
6986 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006987
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08006988connslots <integer>
6989connslots(backend) <integer>
6990 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006991 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08006992 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
6993
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006994 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
6995 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08006996
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006997 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006998 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
6999 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
7000 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
7001 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
7002 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007003 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007004
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007005 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
7006 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
7007 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
7008 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007009
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007010dst <ip_address>
7011 Applies to the local IPv4 address the client connected to. It can be used to
7012 switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007013
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007014dst_conn <integer>
7015 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
7016 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
7017 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
7018 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
7019 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
7020 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
7021
7022dst_port <integer>
7023 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
7024 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
7025
7026fe_conn <integer>
7027fe_conn(frontend) <integer>
7028 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
7029 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
7030 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7031 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
7032 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
7033 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
7034 criteria.
7035
7036fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007037 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007038 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007039
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007040fe_sess_rate <integer>
7041fe_sess_rate(frontend) <integer>
7042 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
7043 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
7044 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
7045 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
7046 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
7047 the rate to go down below the limit.
7048
7049 Example :
7050 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
7051 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
7052 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
7053 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
7054 frontend mail
7055 bind :25
7056 mode tcp
7057 maxconn 100
7058 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
7059 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
7060 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
7061 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007062
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007063nbsrv <integer>
7064nbsrv(backend) <integer>
7065 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
7066 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
7067 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
7068 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
7069 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007070
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007071queue <integer>
Willy Tarreauf5a526f2010-09-01 08:06:18 +02007072queue(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007073 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
7074 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
7075 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
7076 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
7077 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
7078 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
7079 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
7080
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007081sc1_bytes_in_rate
7082sc2_bytes_in_rate
7083 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
7084 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7085 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
7086
7087sc1_bytes_out_rate
7088sc2_bytes_out_rate
7089 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
7090 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7091 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
7092
7093sc1_conn_cnt
7094sc2_conn_cnt
7095 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
7096 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
7097
7098sc1_conn_cur
7099sc2_conn_cur
7100 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
7101 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
7102 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
7103
7104sc1_conn_rate
7105sc2_conn_rate
7106 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
7107 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
7108 See also src_conn_rate.
7109
7110sc1_get_gpc0
7111sc2_get_gpc0
7112 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7113 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
7114
7115sc1_http_err_cnt
7116sc2_http_err_cnt
7117 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
7118 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
7119 See also src_http_err_cnt.
7120
7121sc1_http_err_rate
7122sc2_http_err_rate
7123 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
7124 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
7125 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
7126 src_http_err_rate.
7127
7128sc1_http_req_cnt
7129sc2_http_req_cnt
7130 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7131 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7132 src_http_req_cnt.
7133
7134sc1_http_req_rate
7135sc2_http_req_rate
7136 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7137 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
7138 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7139 src_http_req_rate.
7140
7141sc1_inc_gpc0
7142sc2_inc_gpc0
7143 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
7144 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
7145 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
7146 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
7147 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
7148 when a first ACL was verified :
7149
7150 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7151 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
7152 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7153
7154sc1_kbytes_in
7155sc2_kbytes_in
7156 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
7157 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7158 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7159 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
7160
7161sc1_kbytes_out
7162sc2_kbytes_out
7163 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
7164 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7165 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7166 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
7167
7168sc1_sess_cnt
7169sc2_sess_cnt
7170 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
7171 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
7172 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
7173 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
7174 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performend over the connection
7175 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
7176
7177sc1_sess_rate
7178sc2_sess_rate
7179 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
7180 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
7181 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
7182 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
7183 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
7184 performend over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
7185
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007186so_id <integer>
7187 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
7188
7189src <ip_address>
7190 Applies to the client's IPv4 address. It is usually used to limit access to
7191 certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level source
7192 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
7193
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007194src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
7195src_bytes_in_rate(table) <integer>
7196 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7197 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7198 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007199 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007200
7201src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
7202src_bytes_out_rate(table) <integer>
7203 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
7204 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7205 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007206 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007207
7208src_conn_cnt <integer>
7209src_conn_cnt(table) <integer>
7210 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7211 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7212 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007213 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007214
7215src_conn_cur <integer>
7216src_conn_cur(table) <integer>
7217 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
7218 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
7219 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007220 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007221
7222src_conn_rate <integer>
7223src_conn_rate(table) <integer>
7224 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
7225 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7226 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007227 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007228
7229src_get_gpc0 <integer>
7230src_get_gpc0(table) <integer>
7231 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7232 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7233 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007234 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007235
7236src_http_err_cnt <integer>
7237src_http_err_cnt(table) <integer>
7238 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
7239 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7240 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007241 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007242
7243src_http_err_rate <integer>
7244src_http_err_rate(table) <integer>
7245 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
7246 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
7247 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
7248 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007249 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007250
7251src_http_req_cnt <integer>
7252src_http_req_cnt(table) <integer>
7253 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7254 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7255 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007256 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007257
7258src_http_req_rate <integer>
7259src_http_req_rate(table) <integer>
7260 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7261 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7262 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
7263 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007264 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007265
7266src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
7267src_inc_gpc0(table) <integer>
7268 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7269 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7270 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
7271 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
7272 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
7273 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7274
7275 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7276 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007277 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007278
7279src_kbytes_in <integer>
7280src_kbytes_in(table) <integer>
7281 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
7282 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7283 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7284 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007285 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007286
7287src_kbytes_out <integer>
7288src_kbytes_out(table) <integer>
7289 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
7290 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7291 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7292 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007293 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007294
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007295src_port <integer>
7296 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007297
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007298src_sess_cnt <integer>
7299src_sess_cnt(table) <integer>
7300 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7301 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
7302 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
7303 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007304 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007305
7306src_sess_rate <integer>
7307src_sess_rate(table) <integer>
7308 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7309 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7310 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
7311 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007312 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007313
7314src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
7315src_updt_conn_cnt(table) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007316 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007317 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
7318 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007319 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
7320 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
7321 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007322 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007323
7324 Example :
7325 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
7326 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
7327 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
7328 listen ssh
7329 bind :22
7330 mode tcp
7331 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007332 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007333 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
7334 server local 127.0.0.1:22
7335
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007336srv_id <integer>
7337 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
7338
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02007339srv_is_up(<server>)
7340srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
7341 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
7342 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
7343 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
7344 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
7345 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
7346 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
7347 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
7348 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
7349
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007350
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020073517.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
7352---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007353
7354A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
7355during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007356through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
7357keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007358
7359req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007360 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007361 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
7362 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
7363 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
7364 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
7365 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
7366 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
7367
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007368req_proto_http
7369 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
7370 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007371 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007372 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
7373 using TCP request content inspection rules.
7374
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007375req_rdp_cookie <string>
7376req_rdp_cookie(name) <string>
7377 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
7378 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
7379 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
7380 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
7381 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
7382 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
7383 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
7384 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
7385
7386req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
7387req_rdp_cookie_cnt(name) <integer>
7388 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
7389 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
7390 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
7391 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
7392 cookies.
7393
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007394req_ssl_ver <decimal>
7395 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
7396 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
7397 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
7398 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
7399 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
7400 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
7401 with TCP request content inspection.
7402
Emeric Brun392d1d82010-09-24 15:45:16 +02007403req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7404 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7405 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7406 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
7407 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7408
7409rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7410 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7411 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7412 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
7413 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7414
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02007415wait_end
7416 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
7417 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
7418 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
7419 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
7420 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
7421 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
7422 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
7423 inspection.
7424
7425 Examples :
7426 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
7427 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
7428 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
7429
7430 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
7431 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
7432 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
7433 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
7434 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
7435 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
7436 tcp-request content reject
7437
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007438
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074397.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
7440--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007441
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007442A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007443application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
7444read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
7445than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
7446
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007447hdr <string>
7448hdr(header) <string>
7449 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
7450 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
7451 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
7452 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
7453 Use the shdr() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7454
7455 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
7456 match any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For
7457 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
7458
7459 hdr(Connection) -i close
7460
7461hdr_beg <string>
7462hdr_beg(header) <string>
7463 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
7464 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
7465 response headers sent by the server.
7466
7467hdr_cnt <integer>
7468hdr_cnt(header) <integer>
7469 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
7470 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
7471 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
7472 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
7473 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
7474 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
7475 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7476
7477hdr_dir <string>
7478hdr_dir(header) <string>
7479 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7480 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
7481 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
7482 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
7483 headers sent by the server.
7484
7485hdr_dom <string>
7486hdr_dom(header) <string>
7487 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7488 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
7489 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
7490 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
7491 server.
7492
7493hdr_end <string>
7494hdr_end(header) <string>
7495 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
7496 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
7497 response headers sent by the server.
7498
7499hdr_ip <ip_address>
7500hdr_ip(header) <ip_address>
7501 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IP address matching
7502 <ip_address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For or
7503 X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
7504 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7505
7506hdr_reg <regex>
7507hdr_reg(header) <regex>
7508 Returns true when one of the headers matches of the regular expressions. It
7509 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
7510 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
7511 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
7512 response headers sent by the server.
7513
7514hdr_sub <string>
7515hdr_sub(header) <string>
7516 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
7517 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
7518 response headers sent by the server.
7519
7520hdr_val <integer>
7521hdr_val(header) <integer>
7522 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
7523 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
7524 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
7525 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7526
7527http_auth(userlist)
7528http_auth_group(userlist) <group> [<group>]*
7529 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
7530 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
7531 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
7532 of specified groups.
7533
7534 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
7535
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02007536http_req_first
7537 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
7538 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
7539 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
7540 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
7541
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007542method <string>
7543 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
7544 already check for most common methods.
7545
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007546path <string>
7547 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
7548 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
7549 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
7550
7551path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007552 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
7553 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007554
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007555path_dir <string>
7556 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7557 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
7558 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
7559 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
7560
7561path_dom <string>
7562 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7563 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
7564 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
7565
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007566path_end <string>
7567 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
7568 control file name extension.
7569
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007570path_reg <regex>
7571 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
7572 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
7573 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
7574
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007575path_sub <string>
7576 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
7577 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
7578 "path_dir".
7579
7580req_ver <string>
7581 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
7582 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
7583
7584status <integer>
7585 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
7586 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
7587 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
7588
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007589url <string>
7590 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
7591 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL.
7592
7593url_beg <string>
7594 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
7595 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme.
7596
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007597url_dir <string>
7598 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7599 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
7600 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
7601 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
7602
7603url_dom <string>
7604 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7605 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
7606 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
7607
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007608url_end <string>
7609 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
7610 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007611
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007612url_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007613 Applies to the IP address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request.
7614 It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local network.
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007615 It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007616
7617url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007618 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
7619 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007620 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007621 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007622
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007623url_reg <regex>
7624 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
7625 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
7626 than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007627
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007628url_sub <string>
7629 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
7630 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007631
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007632
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020076337.6. Pre-defined ACLs
7634---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007635
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007636Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
7637every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007638order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007639
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007640ACL name Equivalent to Usage
7641---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007642FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007643HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007644HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
7645HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007646HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
7647HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
7648HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
7649HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
7650LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007651METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
7652METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
7653METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
7654METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
7655METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
7656METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007657RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007658REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007659TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007660WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
7661---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007662
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007663
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020076647.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
7665----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007666
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007667Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
7668combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007669
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007670 - AND (implicit)
7671 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
7672 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007673
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007674A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007675
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007676 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007677
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007678Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
7679indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007680
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007681For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
7682"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
7683requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
7684is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007685
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007686 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
7687 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
7688 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
7689 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007690
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007691To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
7692and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007693
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007694 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7695 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7696 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
7697 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007698
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007699 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
7700 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
7701 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
7702 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007703
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01007704It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
7705expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
7706be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
7707the braces must be seen as independant words). Example :
7708
7709 The following rule :
7710
7711 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
7712 block if METH_POST missing_cl
7713
7714 Can also be written that way :
7715
7716 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
7717
7718It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
7719to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
7720simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
7721sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
7722good use is the following :
7723
7724 With named ACLs :
7725
7726 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7727 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7728 monitor fail if site_dead
7729
7730 With anonymous ACLs :
7731
7732 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
7733
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007734See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007735
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01007736
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010077377.8. Pattern extraction
7738-----------------------
7739
7740The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
7741response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
7742for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
7743
7744All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
7745"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
7746begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
7747arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
7748much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
7749equivalent used in ACLs.
7750
7751The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
7752
7753 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
7754 It is of type IP and only works with such tables.
7755
7756 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
7757 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
7758 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
7759 typie IP and only works with such tables.
7760
7761 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
7762 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
7763 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
7764 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
7765 type integer and only works with such tables.
7766
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02007767 hdr(name) This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
7768 request and converts it to an IP address. This IP address is
7769 then used to match the table. A typical use is with the
7770 x-forwarded-for header.
7771
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007772 payload(offset,length)
7773 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
7774 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
7775 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
7776 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007777
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007778 payload_lv(offset1,length[,offset2])
7779 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
7780 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
7781 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
7782 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
7783 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
7784 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
7785 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
7786 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
7787
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007788The currently available list of transformations include :
7789
7790 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
7791 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
7792 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
7793
7794 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
7795 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
7796 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
7797
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01007798 ipmask(mask) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
7799 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
7800 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
7801 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
7802 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
7803
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007804
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078058. Logging
7806----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007807
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007808One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
7809provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
7810very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
7811provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
7812state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007813to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007814headers.
7815
7816In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
7817about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
7818send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
7819
7820 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
7821 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
7822 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
7823 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
7824 at the termination.
7825
7826The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
7827allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
7828as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
7829while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
7830real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
7831delay.
7832
7833
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078348.1. Log levels
7835---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007836
7837TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with informations such as date, time,
7838source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
7839HTTP request, the HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, the conditions
7840in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values, to track a
7841particular user's problems for example. All messages are sent to up to two
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007842syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more info about log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007843facilities.
7844
7845
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078468.2. Log formats
7847----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007848
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007849HAProxy supports 4 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007850and will be detailed in the next sections. A few of them may slightly vary with
7851the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain options. The supported
7852formats are the following ones :
7853
7854 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
7855 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
7856 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
7857 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
7858 extents.
7859
7860 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
7861 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
7862 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
7863 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
7864 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
7865
7866 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
7867 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
7868 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
7869 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
7870 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
7871
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007872 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
7873 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
7874 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
7875 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
7876
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007877Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
7878specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
7879field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
7880servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
7881always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
7882identifier.
7883
7884Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
7885 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
7886 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
7887 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
7888 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
7889
7890
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078918.2.1. Default log format
7892-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007893
7894This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
7895as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
7896format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
7897
7898 Example :
7899 listen www
7900 mode http
7901 log global
7902 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
7903
7904 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
7905 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
7906 (www/HTTP)
7907
7908 Field Format Extract from the example above
7909 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
7910 2 'Connect from' Connect from
7911 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
7912 4 'to' to
7913 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
7914 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
7915
7916Detailed fields description :
7917 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
7918 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
7919 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
7920 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
7921 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
7922 and processed the connection.
7923 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
7924
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01007925In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
7926"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
7927connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
7928
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007929It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
7930will eventually disappear.
7931
7932
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079338.2.2. TCP log format
7934---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007935
7936The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
7937is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
7938information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
7939counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
7940emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
7941environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
7942the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
7943sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007944specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
7945not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
7946fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
7947marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007948
7949 Example :
7950 frontend fnt
7951 mode tcp
7952 option tcplog
7953 log global
7954 default_backend bck
7955
7956 backend bck
7957 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
7958
7959 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
7960 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
7961 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
7962
7963 Field Format Extract from the example above
7964 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
7965 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
7966 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
7967 4 frontend_name fnt
7968 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
7969 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
7970 7 bytes_read* 212
7971 8 termination_state --
7972 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
7973 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
7974
7975Detailed fields description :
7976 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01007977 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
7978 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
7979 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
7980 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
7981 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007982
7983 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01007984 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
7985 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
7986 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007987
7988 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
7989 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
7990 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
7991 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
7992
7993 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
7994 and processed the connection.
7995
7996 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
7997 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
7998 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
7999 applications.
8000
8001 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
8002 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
8003 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
8004 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
8005 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
8006
8007 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8008 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8009 See "Timers" below for more details.
8010
8011 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8012 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8013 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
8014 "Timers" below for more details.
8015
8016 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8017 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8018 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8019 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8020 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8021 details.
8022
8023 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
8024 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
8025 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
8026 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
8027 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
8028
8029 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8030 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8031 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
8032 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
8033 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
8034 for more details.
8035
8036 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
8037 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
8038 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
8039 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
8040 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008041 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008042
8043 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8044 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8045 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8046 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8047 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8048 caused by a denial of service attack.
8049
8050 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8051 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8052 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8053 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8054 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8055 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8056 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8057 denial of service attack.
8058
8059 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8060 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8061 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8062 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8063 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8064 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
8065 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
8066 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
8067 be processed than on other servers.
8068
8069 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
8070 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
8071 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
8072 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
8073 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
8074 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
8075 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
8076 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
8077 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
8078 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
8079 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
8080 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
8081 should not be attributed to the logged server.
8082
8083 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8084 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
8085 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
8086 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
8087 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
8088 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
8089 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
8090 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
8091
8092 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8093 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
8094 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
8095 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
8096 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
8097 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
8098 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
8099 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
8100 occurs.
8101
8102
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020081038.2.3. HTTP log format
8104----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008105
8106The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
8107is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
8108the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
8109are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
8110emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
8111generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
8112"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
8113which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008114frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
8115is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008116
8117Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
8118slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
8119with a star ('*') after the field name below.
8120
8121 Example :
8122 frontend http-in
8123 mode http
8124 option httplog
8125 log global
8126 default_backend bck
8127
8128 backend static
8129 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8130
8131 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8132 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8133 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008134 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008135
8136 Field Format Extract from the example above
8137 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
8138 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
8139 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
8140 4 frontend_name http-in
8141 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
8142 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
8143 7 status_code 200
8144 8 bytes_read* 2750
8145 9 captured_request_cookie -
8146 10 captured_response_cookie -
8147 11 termination_state ----
8148 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
8149 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8150 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
8151 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
8152 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008153
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008154
8155Detailed fields description :
8156 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008157 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
8158 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
8159 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
8160 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
8161 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008162
8163 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008164 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
8165 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
8166 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008167
8168 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
8169 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
8170 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
8171 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
8172 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
8173
8174 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8175 and processed the connection.
8176
8177 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
8178 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
8179 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
8180
8181 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
8182 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
8183 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
8184 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
8185 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
8186 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
8187
8188 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
8189 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
8190 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
8191 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
8192 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
8193 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
8194
8195 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8196 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8197 See "Timers" below for more details.
8198
8199 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8200 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8201 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
8202 below for more details.
8203
8204 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
8205 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
8206 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
8207 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
8208 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
8209 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
8210 for more details.
8211
8212 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8213 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8214 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8215 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8216 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8217 details.
8218
8219 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
8220 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
8221 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
8222
8223 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
8224 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
8225 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
8226 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
8227 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
8228 overflowing.
8229
8230 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
8231 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
8232 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
8233 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
8234 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
8235 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
8236 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
8237 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
8238
8239 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
8240 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
8241 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
8242 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
8243 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
8244 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
8245 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
8246 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
8247
8248 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8249 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8250 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
8251 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
8252 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
8253 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
8254 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
8255
8256 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
8257 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
8258 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
8259 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
8260 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008261 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008262 system.
8263
8264 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8265 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8266 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8267 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8268 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8269 caused by a denial of service attack.
8270
8271 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8272 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8273 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8274 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8275 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8276 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8277 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8278 denial of service attack.
8279
8280 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8281 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8282 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8283 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8284 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8285 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
8286 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
8287 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
8288 processed than on other servers.
8289
8290 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
8291 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
8292 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
8293 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
8294 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
8295 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
8296 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
8297 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
8298 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
8299 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
8300 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
8301 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
8302 should not be attributed to the logged server.
8303
8304 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8305 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
8306 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
8307 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
8308 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
8309 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
8310 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
8311 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
8312
8313 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8314 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
8315 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
8316 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
8317 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
8318 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
8319 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
8320 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
8321 occurs.
8322
8323 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
8324 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
8325 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
8326 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
8327 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
8328 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
8329 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
8330 cookies" below for more details.
8331
8332 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
8333 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
8334 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
8335 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
8336 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
8337 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
8338 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
8339 and cookies" below for more details.
8340
8341 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
8342 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
8343 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
8344 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
8345 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
8346 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
8347 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
8348 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
8349
8350
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020083518.3. Advanced logging options
8352-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008353
8354Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
8355just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
8356options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
8357for more information about their usage.
8358
8359
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020083608.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
8361------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008362
8363It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
8364haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
8365commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
8366monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
8367ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
8368
8369 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
8370 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
8371 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
8372 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
8373
8374 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
8375 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
8376 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
8377 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
8378 such as other load-balancers.
8379
8380 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
8381 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
8382 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
8383
8384
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020083858.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
8386----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008387
8388The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
8389what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
8390or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
8391"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
8392just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
8393log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
8394after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
8395is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
8396with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
8397with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
8398
8399
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084008.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
8401------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008402
8403Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
8404for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
8405"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
8406retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
8407raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
8408a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
8409file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
8410you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
8411"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
8412
8413
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084148.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
8415--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008416
8417Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
8418multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
8419them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
8420"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
8421logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
8422error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
8423and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
8424too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
8425useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
8426alternative.
8427
8428
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084298.4. Timing events
8430------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008431
8432Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
8433reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
8434the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
8435frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
8436mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
8437
8438 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
8439 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
8440 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
8441 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
8442 the client closes prematurely or times out.
8443
8444 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
8445 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
8446 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
8447 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
8448 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
8449
8450 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
8451 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
8452 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
8453 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
8454 connection never established.
8455
8456 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
8457 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
8458 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
8459 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
8460 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
8461 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
8462 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
8463 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
8464 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
8465 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
8466 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
8467
8468 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
8469 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
8470 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
8471 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
8472 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
8473
8474 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
8475
8476 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
8477 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
8478 negative.
8479
8480These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
8481protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
8482that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008483due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008484close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
8485session has been aborted on timeout.
8486
8487Most common cases :
8488
8489 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
8490 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
8491 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
8492 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
8493 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
8494 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
8495 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
8496 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
8497 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +02008498 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
8499 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
8500 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008501
8502 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
8503 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
8504 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
8505 of ms on remote networks.
8506
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008507 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
8508 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
8509 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008510
8511 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
8512 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
8513 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
8514 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
8515 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
8516 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
8517 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
8518 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
8519 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
8520 to the server until another one is released.
8521
8522Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
8523
8524 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
8525 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
8526 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
8527
8528 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
8529 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
8530 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
8531
8532 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
8533 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
8534 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
8535 flags.
8536
8537 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
8538 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
8539 Check the session termination flags, then check the
8540 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
8541 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
8542 the client connection was maintained open.
8543
8544 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
8545 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
8546 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
8547 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
8548
8549
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085508.5. Session state at disconnection
8551-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008552
8553TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
8554"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
85552-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
8556each of which has a special meaning :
8557
8558 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
8559 session to terminate :
8560
8561 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
8562
8563 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
8564 server explicitly refused it.
8565
8566 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
8567 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
8568 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
8569 error in server response which might have caused information leak
8570 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
8571 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
8572
8573 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
8574 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
8575 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
8576 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
8577 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
8578
8579 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
8580 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
8581 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
8582 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
8583 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
8584
8585 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
8586 send or receive data.
8587
8588 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
8589 send or receive data.
8590
8591 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
8592 with nothing left in the buffers.
8593
8594 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
8595
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01008596 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008597 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
8598
8599 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
8600 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
8601 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
8602 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
8603 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
8604
8605 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
8606 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
8607
8608 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
8609 server (HTTP only).
8610
8611 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
8612
8613 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
8614 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
8615 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
8616
8617 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
8618 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
8619 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
8620
8621 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
8622
8623 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
8624 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
8625
8626 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
8627 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
8628 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
8629
8630 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
8631 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02008632 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
8633 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008634
8635 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
8636 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
8637 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
8638 another server.
8639
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008640 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008641 server.
8642
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008643 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
8644 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
8645 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
8646 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
8647
8648 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
8649 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
8650 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
8651 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
8652
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008653 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
8654
8655 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
8656 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
8657
8658 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
8659
8660 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
8661 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
8662 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
8663
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008664 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
8665 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
8666 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
8667 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
8668 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
8669
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008670 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
8671
8672 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
8673 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
8674
8675 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
8676
8677 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
8678
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008679The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
8680was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008681helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
8682starvation, attacks, etc...
8683
8684The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
8685alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
8686easier finding and understanding.
8687
8688 Flags Reason
8689
8690 -- Normal termination.
8691
8692 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
8693 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
8694 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
8695 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
8696
8697 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
8698 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
8699 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
8700 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
8701 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
8702 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008703
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008704 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
8705 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
8706 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
8707
8708 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
8709 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
8710 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
8711
8712 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
8713 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
8714 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
8715 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
8716 the server takes too long to respond.
8717
8718 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
8719 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
8720 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
8721 long a time to respond.
8722
8723 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
8724 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
8725 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
8726 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
8727 and the client.
8728
8729 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
8730 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
8731 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
8732 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
8733 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
8734 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
8735
8736 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
8737 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008738 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
8739 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
8740 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
8741 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008742
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008743 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008744 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
8745 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
8746 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
8747 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
8748 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
8749
8750 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
8751 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
8752 503 or 504 here.
8753
8754 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
8755 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
8756 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
8757 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
8758 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
8759
8760 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
8761 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008762 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008763 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
8764 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
8765
8766 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
8767 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
8768 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
8769 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
8770 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
8771 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
8772 between haproxy and the server.
8773
8774 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
8775 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
8776 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
8777 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
8778 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
8779 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
8780 solution is to fix the application.
8781
8782 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
8783 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
8784 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
8785 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
8786 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
8787 external attacks.
8788
8789 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
8790 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
8791 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
8792 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
8793 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
8794
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01008795 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
8796 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
8797 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
8798 the client.
8799
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008800 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
8801 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
8802 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
8803 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01008804 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
8805 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
8806 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
8807 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
8808 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008809
8810 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
8811 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
8812 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
8813 returned an HTTP 403 error.
8814
8815 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
8816 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
8817 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
8818 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
8819
8820 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
8821 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
8822 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
8823 only be solved by proper system tuning.
8824
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008825The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
8826persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
8827important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
8828re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
8829
8830 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
8831
8832 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
8833 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
8834 set on a GET request.
8835
8836 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
8837 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
8838 a "server" entry is removed from the configuraton, since its cookie
8839 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
8840
8841 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
8842 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
8843 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
8844
8845 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
8846 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
8847 already got a cookie.
8848
8849 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
8850 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
8851 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
8852 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
8853 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
8854
8855 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
8856 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
8857 new cookie was inserted in the response.
8858
8859 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
8860 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
8861 new cookie was inserted in the response.
8862
8863 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
8864 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
8865
8866 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
8867 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
8868 then advertised in the response.
8869
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008870
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088718.6. Non-printable characters
8872-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008873
8874In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
8875consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
8876converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
8877prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
8878being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
8879escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
8880is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
8881'}' when logging headers.
8882
8883Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
8884issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
8885containing spaces is "User-Agent".
8886
8887Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
8888the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
8889performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
8890
8891
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088928.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
8893---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008894
8895Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
8896achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008897section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008898cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
8899the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
8900the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008901locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008902not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
8903user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
8904a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
8905wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
8906
8907 Examples :
8908 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
8909 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
8910
8911 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
8912 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
8913
8914
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020089158.8. Capturing HTTP headers
8916---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008917
8918Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
8919proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
8920the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
8921server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
8922
8923Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
8924response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008925section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008926
8927It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008928time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
8929appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008930are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
8931and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
8932follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
8933request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
8934in the logs.
8935
8936 Example :
8937 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
8938 listen proxy-out
8939 mode http
8940 option httplog
8941 option logasap
8942 log global
8943 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
8944
8945 # log the name of the virtual server
8946 capture request header Host len 20
8947
8948 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
8949 capture request header Content-Length len 10
8950
8951 # log the beginning of the referrer
8952 capture request header Referer len 20
8953
8954 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
8955 capture response header Server len 20
8956
8957 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
8958 capture response header Content-Length len 10
8959
8960 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
8961 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
8962
8963 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
8964 capture response header Via len 20
8965
8966 # log the URL location during a redirection
8967 capture response header Location len 20
8968
8969 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
8970 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
8971 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
8972 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
8973 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
8974
8975 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
8976 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
8977 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
8978 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008979 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008980
8981 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
8982 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
8983 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
8984 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
8985 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008986 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008987
8988
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020089898.9. Examples of logs
8990---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008991
8992These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
8993them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
8994reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
8995
8996 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
8997 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
8998 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
8999
9000 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
9001 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
9002
9003 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
9004 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
9005 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
9006
9007 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
9008 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
9009
9010 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
9011 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
9012 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9013
9014 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009015 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009016 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
9017 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
9018
9019 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
9020 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
9021 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
9022
9023 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
9024 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
9025 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensible information which
9026 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
9027 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
9028 to return the 502 and not the server.
9029
9030 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009031 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009032
9033 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
9034 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
9035 Nothing was sent to any server.
9036
9037 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
9038 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
9039
9040 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
9041 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
9042 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
9043 send a 408 return code to the client.
9044
9045 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
9046 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
9047
9048 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
9049 5 seconds ("c----").
9050
9051 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
9052 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009053 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009054
9055 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009056 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009057 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
9058 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
9059 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
9060 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
9061 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009062
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009063
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090649. Statistics and monitoring
9065----------------------------
9066
9067It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
9068mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
9069CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
9070Unix socket.
9071
9072
90739.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009074---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009075
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +01009076The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
9077page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
9078
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009079 0. pxname: proxy name
9080 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
9081 for server)
9082 2. qcur: current queued requests
9083 3. qmax: max queued requests
9084 4. scur: current sessions
9085 5. smax: max sessions
9086 6. slim: sessions limit
9087 7. stot: total sessions
9088 8. bin: bytes in
9089 9. bout: bytes out
9090 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009091 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009092 12. ereq: request errors
9093 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01009094 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009095 15. wretr: retries (warning)
9096 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +01009097 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009098 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
9099 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
9100 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
9101 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
9102 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
9103 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
9104 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
9105 25. qlimit: queue limit
9106 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
9107 27. iid: unique proxy id
9108 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
9109 29. throttle: warm up status
9110 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
9111 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009112 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +02009113 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
9114 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
9115 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02009116 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009117 UNK -> unknown
9118 INI -> initializing
9119 SOCKERR -> socket error
9120 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
9121 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
9122 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
9123 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
9124 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
9125 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
9126 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
9127 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
9128 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
9129 disable-on-404
9130 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
9131 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
9132 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02009133 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
9134 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009135 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
9136 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
9137 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
9138 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
9139 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
9140 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009141 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
9142 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
9143 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
9144 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01009145 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
9146 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009147
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009148
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020091499.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009150-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009151
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009152The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009153must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
9154is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
9155a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
9156risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
9157followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
9158given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
9159then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
9160to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009161
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009162It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
9163on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
9164own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009165
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009166clear counters
9167 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
9168 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
9169 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
9170 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
9171 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
9172
9173clear counters all
9174 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
9175 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
9176 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
9177
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009178clear table <table> key <key>
9179 Remove entry <key> from the stick-table <table>. The key must be of the same
9180 type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4. This is typically used
9181 un unblock some users complaining they have been abusively denied access to a
9182 service, but this can also be used to clear some stickiness entries matching
9183 a server that is going to be replaced (see "show table" below for details).
9184 Note that sometimes, removal of a key will be refused because it is currently
9185 tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds later after the session ends is
9186 usuall enough.
9187
9188 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009189 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009190 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009191 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
9192 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
9193 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9194 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009195
9196 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9197
9198 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009199 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009200 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9201 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009202
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009203disable server <backend>/<server>
9204 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
9205 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
9206 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
9207 during the maintenance.
9208
9209 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
9210 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
9211
9212 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
9213 their numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
9214
9215 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9216 level "admin".
9217
9218enable server <backend>/<server>
9219 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
9220 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
9221
9222 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
9223 their numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
9224
9225 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9226 level "admin".
9227
9228get weight <backend>/<server>
9229 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
9230 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
9231 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
9232 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
9233 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
9234 dash ('#').
9235
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009236help
9237 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
9238 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009239
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009240prompt
9241 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
9242 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
9243 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
9244 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
9245 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
9246 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
9247 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
9248 command.
9249
9250quit
9251 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009252
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009253set timeout cli <delay>
9254 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
9255 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
9256 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
9257
9258set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
9259 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
9260 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
9261 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
9262 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
9263 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
9264 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
9265 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
9266 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
9267 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
9268 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
9269 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
9270 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
9271 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
9272 numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
9273
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009274show errors [<iid>]
9275 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
9276 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02009277 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
9278 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
9279 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009280
9281 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
9282 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
9283 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
9284 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
9285 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
9286 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
9287 are reported too.
9288
9289 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
9290 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
9291 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
9292 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
9293 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
9294 code.
9295
9296 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
9297 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
9298 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
9299 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
9300 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
9301 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
9302 line.
9303
9304 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009305 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9306 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009307 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
9308 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
9309
9310 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
9311 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
9312 00038 Location: blah\r\n
9313 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
9314 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
9315 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
9316 00204+ minal\r\n
9317 00211 \r\n
9318
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009319 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009320 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
9321 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
9322 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
9323 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
9324 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
9325 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009326
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009327show info
9328 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
9329
9330show sess
9331 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02009332 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
9333 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
9334
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +01009335show sess <id>
9336 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
9337 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
9338 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
9339 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
9340 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
9341 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009342
9343show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
9344 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
9345 possible to dump only selected items :
9346 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
9347 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
9348 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
9349 for example:
9350 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
9351 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
9352 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
9353
9354 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009355 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
9356 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009357 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
9358 Release_date: 2009/09/23
9359 Nbproc: 1
9360 Process_num: 1
9361 (...)
9362
9363 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
9364 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
9365 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
9366 (...)
9367 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
9368
9369 $
9370
9371 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
9372 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
9373 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
9374 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009375 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009376
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009377show table
9378 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
9379 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
9380 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
9381 entries currently in use.
9382
9383 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009384 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9385 >>> # table: front_pub, type: 0, size:204800, used:171454
9386 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: 0, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009387
9388show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ]
9389 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
9390 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
9391 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
9392 a filter in order to specify what entries to display. The filter then applies
9393 to the stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2). One stored data type
9394 has to be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table
9395 otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator>
9396 with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
9397 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
9398 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
9399 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
9400 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
9401 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
9402 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
9403
9404 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009405 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9406 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
9407 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
9408 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
9409 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9410 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009411
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009412 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9413 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
9414 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9415 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009416
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009417 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
9418 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9419 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
9420 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9421 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009422
9423 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
9424 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
9425 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
9426 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
9427 time goes, the average event rate drops.
9428
9429 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
9430 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
9431 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009432 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
9433 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009434 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
9435 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +02009436
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009437/*
9438 * Local variables:
9439 * fill-column: 79
9440 * End:
9441 */